VIATEL INC
S-1, 1996-08-07
TELEPHONE COMMUNICATIONS (NO RADIOTELEPHONE)
Previous: EPL TECHNOLOGIES INC, S-3, 1996-08-07
Next: SCP POOL CORP, 10-Q, 1996-08-07



<PAGE>   1
 
     AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON AUGUST 7, 1996
 
                                                   REGISTRATION NO. 333-
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                            ------------------------
 
                                    FORM S-1
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                            ------------------------
 
                                  VIATEL, INC.
             (EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                       <C>                       <C>
         DELAWARE                    4813                   13-3787366
     (STATE OR OTHER          (PRIMARY STANDARD          (I.R.S. EMPLOYER
        JURISDICTION              INDUSTRIAL           IDENTIFICATION NO.)
   OF INCORPORATION OR       CLASSIFICATION CODE
      ORGANIZATION)                NUMBER)
</TABLE>
 
                                800 Third Avenue
                            New York, New York 10022
                                 (212) 935-6800
  (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF
                   REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)
                            ------------------------
 
                            SHELDON M. GOLDMAN, ESQ.
                              U.S. GENERAL COUNSEL
                                  VIATEL, INC.
                                800 Third Avenue
                            New York, New York 10022
                                 (212) 935-6800
 (NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE,
                             OF AGENT FOR SERVICE)
                            ------------------------
 
                                   COPIES TO:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                           <C>
            JOHN T. CAPETTA, ESQ.                      GEORGE W. BILICIC, JR., ESQ.
           KELLEY DRYE & WARREN LLP                      CRAVATH, SWAINE & MOORE
              Two Stamford Plaza                             Worldwide Plaza
            281 Tresser Boulevard                           825 Eighth Avenue
         Stamford, Connecticut 06901                     New York, New York 10019
                (203) 324-1400                                (212) 474-1000
</TABLE>
 
                            ------------------------
 
   APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE OF THE SECURITIES TO THE
                                    PUBLIC:
  As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.
 
    If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on
a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of
1933, check the following box:  / /
 
    If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933, please check the
following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the
earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  / /
 
    If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c)
under the Securities Act of 1933, please check the following box and list the
Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective
registration statement for the same offering.  / /
 
    If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434
under the Securities Act of 1933, please check the following box.  / /
                            ------------------------
 
                        CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                        <C>                      <C>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                   PROPOSED
                                                    MAXIMUM
          TITLE OF EACH CLASS OF                   AGGREGATE                AMOUNT OF
        SECURITIES TO BE REGISTERED            OFFERING PRICE(1)       REGISTRATION FEE(1)
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Common Stock, par value $.01 per share.....      $135,000,000.00           $46,553.00
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
 
(1) Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee
    pursuant to Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933.
                            ------------------------
 
    THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL
FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME
EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A),
MAY DETERMINE.
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   2
 
                                  VIATEL, INC.
 
            CROSS-REFERENCE SHEET SHOWING LOCATION IN PROSPECTUS OF
              INFORMATION REQUIRED BY ITEMS IN PART I OF FORM S-1
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   FORM S-1 ITEM NUMBER
                        AND HEADING                               LOCATION IN PROSPECTUS
       ---------------------------------------------   ---------------------------------------------
<C>    <S>                                             <C>
  1.   Forepart of the Registration Statement and
       Outside Front Cover Page of Prospectus.......   Outside Front Cover Page
  2.   Inside Front and Outside Back Cover Pages of
       Prospectus...................................   Inside Front Cover Page; Additional
                                                       Information; Outside Back Cover Page
  3.   Summary Information, Risk Factors and Ratio
       of Earnings to Fixed Charges.................   Prospectus Summary; Risk Factors
  4.   Use of Proceeds..............................   Prospectus Summary; Use of Proceeds
  5.   Determination of Offering Price..............   Outside Front Cover Page; Risk Factors;
                                                       Underwriting
  6.   Dilution.....................................   Dilution
  7.   Selling Security Holders.....................   Not Applicable
  8.   Plan of Distribution.........................   Outside Front Cover Page; Underwriting
  9.   Description of Securities to be Registered...   Outside Front Cover Page; Prospectus Summary;
                                                       Dividend Policy; Description of Capital
                                                       Stock; Shares Eligible For Future Sale
 10.   Interests of Named Experts and Counsel.......   Not Applicable
 11.   Information with Respect to the Registrant
       (a)    Description of Business................   Prospectus Summary; Business
       (b)    Description of Property................   Business
       (c)    Legal Proceedings......................   Business
       (d)    Market Price of and Dividends on the
              Registrant's Common Equity and Related
              Stockholder Matters....................   Dividend Policy; Description of Capital Stock
       (e)    Financial Statements...................   Consolidated Financial Statements
       (f)    Selected Consolidated Financial Data...   Selected Consolidated Financial and Other
                                                        Data
       (g)    Supplementary Financial Information....   Prospectus Summary; Selected Consolidated
                                                        Financial and Other Data; Management's
                                                        Discussion and Analysis of Financial
                                                        Condition and Results of Operations
       (h)    Management's Discussion and Analysis of
              Financial Condition and Results of
              Operations.............................   Management's Discussion and Analysis of
                                                        Financial Condition and Results of Operations
       (i)    Changes in and Disagreements with
              Accountants on Accounting and Financial
              Disclosure.............................   Not Applicable
       (j)    Directors and Executive Officers.......   Management
       (k)    Executive Compensation.................   Management
       (l)    Security Ownership of Certain
              Beneficial Owners and Management.......   Principal Stockholders; Shares Eligible For
                                                        Future Sale
       (m)    Certain Relationships and Related
              Transactions...........................   Certain Transactions
 12.   Disclosure of Commission Position on
       Indemnification for Securities Act
       Liabilities..................................   Not Applicable
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   3
 
                                EXPLANATORY NOTE
 
     This Registration Statement contains two forms of prospectus: one to be
used in connection with an underwritten offering in the United States and Canada
(the "U.S. Prospectus") and one to be used in a concurrent international
offering (the "International Prospectus") of the Common Stock, par value $.01
per share, of Viatel, Inc. The complete prospectus for the offering in the
United States and Canada follows immediately after this Explanatory Note. After
the U.S. Prospectus are the alternate pages for the International Prospectus: a
front cover page, an "Underwriting" section, a "Certain United States Tax
Considerations For Non-United States Holders" section and a back cover page. A
copy of the complete U.S. Prospectus and International Prospectus in the exact
forms in which they are to be used after effectiveness will be filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b).
<PAGE>   4
 
     INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
     REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
     MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
     BECOMES EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
     THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
     SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE
     UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS
     OF ANY SUCH STATE.
 
                             Subject to Completion
 
                                 August 7, 1996
PROSPECTUS
 
                                    SHARES
                                                                            LOGO
VIATEL, INC.
 
COMMON STOCK
($.01 PAR VALUE)
 
All of the shares of common stock (the "Common Stock") offered hereby are being
sold by Viatel, Inc. (the "Company" or "Viatel"). Of the             shares of
Common Stock offered,             shares are being offered by the U.S.
Underwriters (as defined herein) in the United States and Canada (the "U.S.
Offering") and             shares are being offered by the International
Underwriters (as defined herein), in a concurrent offering outside the United
States and Canada (the "International Offering" and together with the U.S.
Offering, the "Offerings"), subject to transfers between the U.S. Underwriters
and the International Underwriters (collectively, the "Underwriters"). The
initial public offering price and the aggregate underwriting discount per share
will be identical for the Offerings. See "Underwriting." The closing of the U.S.
Offering and the International Offering are conditioned upon each other.
 
Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common Stock. It
is currently estimated that the initial public offering price per share will be
between $            and $            . See "Underwriting" for a discussion of
the factors considered in determining the initial public offering price.
 
Application has been made to have the shares of Common Stock approved for
quotation on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "VYTL."
 
SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 7 FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS THAT
SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY POTENTIAL INVESTORS.
 
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                    PROCEEDS
                                               PRICE TO          UNDERWRITING          TO
                                                PUBLIC             DISCOUNT        COMPANY(1)
<S>                                        <C>                 <C>                 <C>
Per Share................................  $                   $                   $
Total(2).................................  $                   $                   $
</TABLE>
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) Before deducting offering expenses payable by the Company, estimated at
    $          .
(2) The Company has granted the Underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to
    an aggregate of           additional shares of Common Stock at the Price to
    Public, less the Underwriting Discount, solely to cover over-allotments, if
    any. If the Underwriters exercise such option in full, the total Price to
    Public, Underwriting Discount and Proceeds to Company will be $          ,
    $          and $          , respectively. See "Underwriting."
 
The shares of Common Stock are offered subject to receipt and acceptance by the
Underwriters, to prior sale and to the Underwriters' right to reject any order
in whole or in part and to withdraw, cancel or modify the offer without notice.
It is expected that delivery of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby will
be made at the office of Salomon Brothers Inc, Seven World Trade Center, New
York, New York, or through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company, on or
about                     , 1996.
- -------------------------------------------------
SALOMON BROTHERS INC
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The date of this Prospectus is                     , 1996.
<PAGE>   5
 
                            ------------------------
 
     The Company intends to furnish its stockholders with annual reports
containing consolidated financial statements audited by an independent
accounting firm.
 
                            ------------------------
 
     IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERINGS, THE UNDERWRITERS MAY OVER-ALLOT OR EFFECT
TRANSACTIONS WHICH STABILIZE OR MAINTAIN THE MARKET PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK OF
THE COMPANY AT A LEVEL ABOVE THAT WHICH MIGHT OTHERWISE PREVAIL IN THE OPEN
MARKET. SUCH TRANSACTIONS MAY BE EFFECTED ON THE NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET, IN THE
OVER-THE-COUNTER MARKET OR OTHERWISE. SUCH STABILIZING, IF COMMENCED, MAY BE
DISCONTINUED AT ANY TIME.
 
                                        2
<PAGE>   6
 
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by and should be read in
conjunction with the more detailed information and Consolidated Financial
Statements, including the Notes thereto, and other financial data appearing
elsewhere in this Prospectus. Except as otherwise indicated, all information in
this Prospectus (i) assumes an initial public offering price of $          per
share of Common Stock and no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option
and (ii) has been adjusted to give effect to the conversion of all outstanding
shares of the Company's non-voting Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value (the
"Class A Common Stock") into shares of Common Stock. As used herein, the terms
"Company" and "Viatel" refer to Viatel, Inc. and its subsidiaries and
predecessor, and the term "Latin America" refers to the United Mexican States,
Central America and South America, collectively. All industry data included in
this Prospectus, including that of the International Telecommunications Union
("ITU"), has been presented as of 1994, the most recent year for which such data
is available. See the "Glossary" appearing elsewhere herein for definitions of
certain technical terms used in this Prospectus.
 
                                  THE COMPANY
 
     Viatel is a growing provider of international and national long distance
telecommunications services principally in Western Europe, Latin America, the
United States and the Pacific Rim and offers its services primarily to small and
medium-sized businesses, carriers and other resellers. The Company operates a
digital, switch-based telecommunications network in Western Europe including a
central switching center in London and additional switches in Amsterdam,
Barcelona, Brussels, Frankfurt, Madrid, Milan, Paris and Rome connected by
leased, digital fiber optic transmission facilities (the "European Network"). In
addition, the Company operates a switching center in Omaha, Nebraska which is
connected to the central switching center in London by leased, digital fiber
optic transmission facilities (together with the European Network, the "Viatel
Network"). The Company has achieved rapid growth since its inception in 1991
with telecommunications revenue reaching $32.3 million in 1995 and $10.6 million
during the three months ended March 31, 1996.
 
     The Company derives revenue primarily through the provision of
competitively priced long distance services with value-added features that are
not typically provided by the respective incumbent telecommunications operator
("ITO") in many of the countries in which the Company operates. The Company's
services include virtual private networks, dedicated access for high volume
users, calling cards, fax service and the provision of switched minutes to
wholesale customers. The value-added features include itemized and multicurrency
billing, abbreviated dialing and multiple payment methods. Access to the
Company's services is obtained through callback, paid access, international
toll-free ("ITF"), national toll-free ("NTF") or direct access through a
dedicated line.
 
     The Company conducts its business on a global basis, with its principal
focus on Western Europe. Of the Company's telecommunications revenue for the
three months ended March 31, 1996, approximately 42.5% was generated in Western
Europe, approximately 29.6% was generated in Latin America, approximately 12.8%
was generated in North America, primarily from the Company's wholesale business
of selling switched minutes to other carriers, and approximately 11.6% was
generated in the Pacific Rim. The remaining 3.5% was generated in Africa and the
Middle East.
 
     The Company's objective is to be a significant provider of international
and national long distance telecommunications services within Western Europe and
other deregulating markets. The Company believes it is strategically positioned
to take advantage of fundamental changes occurring in the telecommunications
industry as a result of global deregulation and rapid advances in technology. In
particular, the Company believes that its early entry into the Western European
market as an alternative network operator has positioned it to take advantage of
the anticipated implementation of the European Union's ("EU") directives to
eliminate the ITOs' existing monopolies on Voice Telephony (as defined herein),
scheduled to occur by 1998 in most EU member states. The Company is currently
prohibited from supplying Voice Telephony in most EU member states until 1998.
Accordingly, the Company instead provides competitively priced international and
national long distance services with value-added features,
 
                                        3
<PAGE>   7
 
thus positioning itself to capitalize on anticipated deregulation. Key elements
of the Company's business strategy include: (i) focusing on the European market
and leveraging the European Network; (ii) capitalizing on the anticipated
obsolescence of settlement agreements with ITOs; (iii) maintaining low-cost
operations; (iv) focusing on the Company's target market of small and
medium-sized businesses; (v) increasing sales of switched minutes to wholesale
customers; (vi) continuing the development of the Company's local sales
distribution channels; (vii) leveraging the Company's information systems; and
(viii) pursuing acquisitions, investments and strategic alliances.
 
     The Company believes it is well positioned to achieve its objective as a
result of its: (i) switch-based network capabilities; (ii) early entry into the
Western European market as an alternative network operator; (iii) focus on
international and national long distance telecommunications traffic; (iv)
competitively priced services and value-added features; and (v) local sales,
marketing and customer service organizations.
 
     The Company is a Delaware corporation and is the successor to VIA USA, Ltd.
(a Colorado corporation) which was merged into the Company on October 11, 1994
to effectuate a reincorporation within the State of Delaware. The Company is an
operating company which renders its services directly and indirectly through
subsidiaries in each Western European country in which it currently operates.
The Company's principal executive offices are located at 800 Third Avenue, New
York, New York 10022. Its telephone number is (212) 935-6800.
 
                                 THE OFFERINGS
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                        <C>
Common Stock offered hereby:
     U.S. Offering......................   shares
     International Offering.............   shares
                                           -----------
          Total(1)......................   shares
                                           -----------
                                           -----------
Common Stock outstanding after the
  Offerings(1)(2).......................   shares
Use of proceeds.........................   The net proceeds of the Offerings, estimated to be
                                           approximately $108.0 million (approximately $124.4
                                           million if the Underwriters' over-allotment option
                                           is exercised in full), will be used by the Company
                                           for (i) network upgrade and expansion; (ii)
                                           investments in digital undersea fiber optic cable;
                                           (iii) acquisitions of customer bases and businesses
                                           or for investment in joint ventures or strategic
                                           alliances; and (iv) general corporate and working
                                           capital purposes, including feasibility studies of
                                           the Company's provision of competitive local
                                           exchange carrier ("CLEC") services. See "Risk
                                           Factors -- Broad Discretion Over Use of Proceeds"
                                           and "Use of Proceeds."
Proposed Nasdaq National Market
  symbol................................   VYTL
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Does not include up to an aggregate of         shares of Common Stock
    subject to an over-allotment option granted to the Underwriters. See
    "Underwriting."
 
(2) Excludes (i) 1,750,000 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under
    the Stock Incentive Plan (as defined herein) of which options to purchase
    1,294,078 shares of Common Stock, exercisable at prices ranging from $.50 to
    $3.90 per share, have been granted and are outstanding on the date hereof
    and (ii) 8,871 other outstanding options to purchase shares of Common Stock
    exercisable at $.50 per share. See "Management -- Stock Incentive Plan."
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 7 for a discussion of certain factors
that should be considered by potential investors.
 
                                        4
<PAGE>   8
 
                 SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA
 
     The following summary Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Other
Financial Data as of and for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993
have been derived from the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company, and
the Notes related thereto, included elsewhere in this Prospectus, which were
audited by KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent Certified Public Accountants. The
summary Consolidated Statement of Operations Data, Other Financial Data and
Balance Sheet Data as of and for the three-months ended March 31, 1996 and the
Statement of Operations Data and Other Financial Data as of and for the three
months ended March 31, 1995 have been derived from the unaudited Consolidated
Financial Statements of the Company, and the Notes related thereto, included
elsewhere in this Prospectus, which, in the opinion of management, include all
adjustments necessary for a fair presentation of the financial condition and
results of operations of the Company for such periods. The results of operations
for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of a full year's operations.
This information should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements, including the Notes thereto, and the other
financial data included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   THREE MONTHS
                                                 ENDED MARCH 31,                 YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                              ----------------------      --------------------------------------
                                                1996          1995          1995           1994           1993
                                              --------      --------      ---------      ---------      --------
<S>                                           <C>           <C>           <C>            <C>            <C>
                                                   (UNAUDITED)
                                                        (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT OTHER OPERATING DATA)(1)
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
  Telecommunications revenue...............   $ 10,590      $  6,929      $  32,313      $  26,268      $ 21,393
  Operating expenses:
    Cost of telecommunications services....      8,999         5,900         27,648         22,953        18,159
    Selling expenses.......................      2,401         1,537          7,468          4,459         2,389
    General and administrative expense.....      5,129         2,903         16,860          9,859         6,069
    Depreciation and amortization..........      1,088           499          2,637            789           111
    Equipment impairment loss..............         --            --            560             --            --
                                               -------       -------        -------        -------       -------
      Total operating expenses.............     17,617        10,839         55,173         38,060        26,728
                                               -------       -------        -------        -------       -------
  Operating loss...........................   $ (7,027)     $ (3,909)     $ (22,860)     $ (11,792)     $ (5,335)
  Interest income (expense), net...........     (2,099)       (1,053)        (5,574)          (558)           21
  Share in loss of affiliate...............         (1)          (12)           (42)          (145)         (142)
                                               -------       -------        -------        -------       -------
  Net loss.................................   $ (9,127)     $ (4,974)     $ (28,476)     $ (12,495)     $ (5,456)
                                               =======       =======        =======        =======       =======
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
  EBITDA(2)................................   $ (5,939)     $ (3,410)     $ (20,223)     $ (11,003)     $ (5,224)
  Capital expenditures, including
    acquisitions of businesses.............   $  3,227      $  3,134      $  11,378      $   4,843      $  2,643
OTHER OPERATING DATA(3):
  Billable minutes (000's)(4)..............     10,866         4,603         25,932         14,981        10,899
  Average revenue per billable minute(5)...   $   0.95      $   1.50      $    1.23      $    1.70      $   1.87
  Average cost per billable minute(6)......   $   0.78      $   1.28      $    1.04      $    1.53      $   1.67
  Switches(7)(8)...........................         11             2             10              2             2
  Customers(7).............................     11,363         6,922          9,218          6,469         5,486
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                         --------------------------------
                                                                          ACTUAL         AS ADJUSTED(9)
                                                                         ---------     ------------------
<S>                                                                      <C>           <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
  Working capital.....................................................   $  18,146
  Property and equipment, net.........................................      17,590
  Total assets........................................................      57,483
  Long-term debt......................................................      69,791
  Stockholders' (deficit) equity......................................     (26,638)
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Amounts presented may not total due to rounding.
 
                                        5
<PAGE>   9
 
(2) As used herein "EBITDA" consists of earnings before interest (net), income
    taxes, depreciation and amortization and share in loss of affiliate. EBITDA
    is a measure commonly used in the telecommunications industry to analyze
    companies on the basis of operating performance. EBITDA is not a measure of
    financial performance under generally accepted accounting principles and
    should not be considered as an alternative to net income as a measure of
    performance nor as an alternative to cash flow as a measure of liquidity.
 
(3) Information derived from operating records prepared by the Company.
 
(4) Billable minutes are those minutes during which a call is connected at any
    Company switch and for which the Company bills a customer.
 
(5) Represents the gross call usage revenue per billable minute. Amounts exclude
    other revenue and revenue related items such as hardware sales, software
    licensing, credits, discounts and other non-usage charges.
 
(6) Represents the cost associated with the Company's provision of
    telecommunications services per billable minute. Amounts exclude
    nontransmission costs such as hardware and software purchased for resale.
 
(7) Information presented as of the end of the period indicated.
 
(8) For the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the year ended December 31,
    1995, includes two switches at the Omaha, Nebraska switching center and one
    switch at each of the Company's other switching sites.
 
(9) Adjusted to give effect to the Offerings and the estimated net proceeds
    therefrom. See "Use of Proceeds" and "Capitalization."
 
                                        6
<PAGE>   10
 
           CAUTIONARY STATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
 
     Certain statements contained in "Risk Factors," "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business,"
including statements regarding the anticipated development and expansion of the
Company's businesses, the markets in which the Company's services are offered,
anticipated capital expenditures and regulatory reform, the intent, belief or
current expectations of the Company, its directors or its officers, primarily
with respect to the future operating performance of the Company and other
statements contained herein regarding matters that are not historical facts, are
"forward-looking" statements (as such term is defined in the Private Securities
Litigation Reform Act of 1995). Because such statements include risks and
uncertainties, actual results may differ materially from those expressed or
implied by such forward-looking statements. Factors that could cause actual
results to differ materially from those expressed or implied by such
forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, the factors set
forth in "Risk Factors" and "Business."
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     In addition to the other information and financial data set forth elsewhere
in this Prospectus, potential investors should consider the following risk
factors in evaluating the Company and its business before purchasing the shares
of Common Stock offered hereby.
 
LIMITED OPERATING HISTORY; SUBSTANTIAL NET LOSSES AND NEGATIVE CASH FLOW FROM
OPERATIONS
 
     The Company commenced operations in 1991 and has only a limited operating
history upon which potential investors may base an evaluation of its
performance. To date, the Company has incurred substantial net losses and
negative EBITDA. Net loss for each of 1995, 1994 and 1993 and the three months
ended March 31, 1996 was approximately $(28.5) million, $(12.5) million, $(5.5)
million and $(9.1) million, respectively. EBITDA for each of 1995, 1994 and 1993
and for the three months ended March 31, 1996 was approximately $(20.2) million,
$(11.0) million, $(5.2) million and $(5.9) million, respectively. At March 31,
1996, the Company had incurred $56.7 million of aggregate losses from operating
activities. In each of the last three years, the Company has experienced
significant increases in expenses associated with the development and expansion
of the Viatel Network. The Company expects to incur substantial net losses,
negative EBITDA and negative cash flows from operating activities until at least
the year 2001. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will achieve
or sustain profitability or positive cash flows from operating activities in the
future. If the Company cannot achieve profitability or positive cash flows from
operating activities, it may be unable to meet its working capital or future
debt service requirements which would have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"-- Substantial Capital Requirements," "-- Variability of Operating Results,"
"Selected Consolidated Financial and Other Data," "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements, including the Notes thereto.
 
SUBSTANTIAL GOVERNMENT REGULATION
 
     The Company's provision of international and national long distance
telecommunications services is heavily regulated. Many of the countries in which
the Company provides, or intends to provide, services prohibit or limit the
services which the Company can provide and the transmission methods by which it
can provide such services. For example, in the United States, the Company's
authority to engage in the resale of international private line communications
services is pursuant to the authorization (the "Section 214 Private Line
Authorization") granted to YYC Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company,
under Section 214 of the Communications Act of 1934, as amended (the
"Communications Act"). Certain rules of the Federal Communications Commission
("FCC") prohibit the Company from (i) transmitting calls routed over the
Company's leased line between the United States and the United Kingdom onward
over the European Network (other than to countries which the FCC deems to be
"equivalent," currently the United Kingdom, Canada and Sweden) or (ii)
transmitting calls from European countries (other than
 
                                        7
<PAGE>   11
 
those deemed to be equivalent) over the European Network and then onward over
its leased line between the United States and the United Kingdom. If a violation
of FCC rules concerning resale of international private line service were found
to exist and to be sufficiently severe, the FCC could impose sanctions and
penalties including revocation of the Section 214 Private Line Authorization.
FCC restrictions thus materially limit the optimal and most profitable use of
the Company's leased line between the United States and the United Kingdom.
 
     In addition, the Company provides its customers located outside the EU,
and, to a lesser degree within the EU, with access to its services through the
use of callback. A substantial number of countries have prohibited certain forms
of callback as a mechanism to access the Company's services. This has caused the
Company to cease providing services in some jurisdictions, including Kuwait,
Costa Rica and Jordan, and may require it to do so in other countries in the
future. There can be no assurance that certain of the Company's services and
transmission methods will not continue to be or will not become prohibited in
certain jurisdictions, and, depending on the jurisdictions, services and
transmission methods affected, there could be a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"Business -- Government Regulation."
 
     Local laws and regulations differ significantly among the jurisdictions in
which the Company operates, and, within such jurisdictions, the interpretation
and enforcement of such laws and regulations can be unpredictable. For example,
EU member states have inconsistently and, in some instances, unclearly
implemented the 1990 EU directive (the "Services Directive") under which the
Company provides voice services for closed user groups ("CUGs") in Western
Europe. As a result, some EU member states may limit, constrain or otherwise
adversely affect the Company's ability to provide certain services. There can be
no assurance that certain EU member states will implement, or will implement
consistently, the Services Directive or the Full Competition Directive adopted
by the EU in March 1996 (the "Full Competition Directive"), and either the
failure to implement or inconsistent implementation of such directives could
have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition
and results of operations.
 
     The Company has pursued and expects to continue to pursue a strategy of
providing its services to the maximum extent it believes permissible under
applicable laws and regulations. For example, the Company provides its ViaGLOBE
service to individuals for calling within the EU and such service may constitute
prohibited Voice Telephony. A further example of the Company's aggressive
interpretation of indefinite or unfavorable laws is its provision of services
utilizing the callback access method in Colombia, where the Colombian Ministry
of Communications has stated that callback access is not permitted and has so
notified the FCC, and in other Latin American countries, where services
utilizing such access method may not currently be permitted.
 
     The Company's aggressive strategy may result in the Company's (i) providing
services or using transmission methods that violate local laws or regulations or
(ii) failing to obtain formal approvals required under such laws or regulations.
Where the Company is found to be in violation of local laws and regulations, it
usually seeks to modify its operations so as to comply with such laws and
regulations. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will not be
subject to fines, penalties or other sanctions as a result of past violations
even though such violations were corrected. In addition, if the Company believes
that it has a legal basis for doing so, it may persist in providing such
services, using such transmission methods, or otherwise continuing such actions.
If the Company's interpretation of applicable laws and regulations proves
incorrect, it could lose, or be unable to obtain, regulatory approvals,
including the Section 214 Private Line Authorization or the Section 214 Switched
Authorization (as defined herein), necessary to provide certain of its services
or to use certain of its transmission methods. The Company also could have
substantial monetary fines and penalties imposed against it. In addition, the
Section 214 Private Line Authorization requires that services be provided "in a
manner consistent with the laws and regulations of the countries in which [the
Company] operates." There can be no assurance that the Company has accurately
interpreted or will accurately interpret applicable laws and regulations in
particular jurisdictions.
 
                                        8
<PAGE>   12
 
     The Company may be incorrect in its assumption that (i) EU member states
will abolish on a timely basis the respective ITO's monopoly to provide Voice
Telephony within and between such member states, as required by the Services
Directive and the Full Competition Directive, (ii) deregulation will continue to
occur or (iii) it will be allowed to continue to provide and to expand its
services. The Company's provision of services in Europe may also be affected if
any EU member state imposes greater restrictions on non-EU international service
than on such service within the EU. There can be no assurance that the United
States or foreign jurisdictions will not adopt laws or regulatory requirements
that will adversely affect the Company. Additionally, there can be no assurance
that future United States or foreign regulatory, judicial or legislative changes
will not have a material adverse effect on the Company or that regulators or
third parties will not raise material issues with regard to the Company's
compliance with applicable laws or regulations. If the Company is unable to
provide the services it is presently providing or intends to provide or to use
its existing or contemplated transmission methods due to its inability to
receive or retain formal or informal approvals for such services or transmission
methods, or for any other reason related to regulatory compliance or the lack
thereof, such events could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"Business -- Government Regulation."
 
POTENTIAL DIFFICULTIES ASSOCIATED WITH IMPLEMENTING EUROPEAN EXPANSION STRATEGY
 
     The Company believes that an increasing percentage of its future revenue
will be derived from its Western European business operations. Execution of the
Company's European expansion strategy, however, is subject to a variety of
risks, including operating and technical problems, regulatory uncertainties,
possible delays in the full implementation of the Services Directive and
competition. The successful implementation of its European expansion strategy
will require that the Company, among other things, continue to develop its
European Network, back-office capacity and direct sales organizations. There can
be no assurance that the Company will successfully implement its European
expansion strategy or that the Company's Western European operations will
contribute an increasing percentage of revenue in the future.
 
     Expansion and development of the European Network are necessary to enable
the Company to meet customer requirements and to increase the number of
customers served, thereby increasing traffic volume which is fundamental to the
achievement of economies of scale and to the Company's overall financial
success. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will be able to
expand and develop the European Network successfully. The European Network
enables the Company to operate in the Western European market on a competitive
basis. The primary economic benefits of the European Network, however, are
limited to those calls that either originate or terminate in a city where the
Company has a switch or point of presence ("POP"). The Company currently incurs
significant fixed costs associated with the operation of the European Network,
consisting principally of leased line rental charges and local connectivity and
facility/network management costs. Although the current traffic volume through
the European portion of the Company's network is too low to achieve desired
economies of scale, transmission costs are expected to decline as a percentage
of revenue as call traffic through the European Network increases. There can be
no assurance, however, that the European Network will ever achieve the economies
of scale which the Company believes are critical to its overall financial
success.
 
     To originate and terminate calls on the European Network, the Company
requires "local connectivity," which is access and egress into and from the
public switched telephone network ("PSTN"). Although the Company has been
successful to date in obtaining local connectivity, there can be no assurance
that the Company will be able to maintain local connectivity or that local
connectivity will always be obtained. Currently, the Company obtains its local
connectivity from the local ITOs which are, and are expected to continue to be,
the Company's competitors in the future.
 
     In addition, under a prior configuration, the Company experienced problems
affecting the quality of the voice and voice band data transmission of some
calls transmitted over the European Network. These problems resulted from time
to time in poor quality voice transmission over the European Network and, in
some instances, resulted in interruptions in service. There can be no assurance
that the European
 
                                        9
<PAGE>   13
 
Network will not experience quality problems or service interruptions in the
future. To provide redundancy in the event of technical difficulties with the
European Network, the Company relies upon the PSTN. To the extent that calls are
transmitted over the PSTN rather than over the European Network, these calls
will be more costly to the Company and may result in losses on such calls.
 
     Any failure to expand and develop the European Network successfully would
have a material adverse effect on the Company's ability to implement its
European expansion strategy, which is a key component of its overall business
strategy. Failure to implement successfully the Company's European expansion
strategy, or future problems with local connectivity, quality of service or
service interruptions would have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. See "-- Substantial
Government Regulation," "-- Competition," "-- Risks Associated with
International Operations," "Business -- Business Strategy," "Business -- The
Viatel Network -- The European Network" and "Business -- Competition."
 
SUBSTANTIAL CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS
 
     The development of the Company's business has, in the past, required
substantial capital expenditures. In the future, the Company will require
substantial capital expenditures significantly in excess of historical levels to
expand and upgrade the Viatel Network generally, and the European Network
specifically, as well as to develop and expand new and existing services. During
the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993 and the three months ended
March 31, 1996, the Company had capital expenditures, including acquisitions of
businesses, of approximately $11.4 million, $4.8 million, $2.6 million and $3.2
million, respectively.
 
     The Company expects to use the net proceeds of the Offerings to meet its
capital expenditure requirements and estimates that it will use approximately
(i) $32.2 million of the net proceeds of the Offerings for network upgrade and
expansion, (ii) $9.0 million for investment in digital undersea fiber optic
cable, (iii) $20.0 million for acquisitions of customer bases and businesses or
for investment in joint ventures or strategic alliances, and (iv) $46.8 million
for general corporate and working capital purposes, including up to
approximately $1.0 million for feasibility studies of the Company's provision of
CLEC services. See "-- Broad Discretion Over Use of Proceeds" and "Use of
Proceeds." Although the Company believes that the proceeds of the Offerings will
be sufficient to fund its current plans, actual capital expenditures may vary
significantly from the Company's estimates depending on a number of factors,
including the pace and extent of network upgrade and expansion, the magnitude of
potential acquisitions, investments or strategic alliances, levels of
incremental sales and regulatory actions, which, individually or collectively,
could cause material changes in the Company's capital expenditure requirements.
 
     The Company will need additional capital to (i) finance its anticipated
growth, (ii) fund working capital needs and future debt service obligations,
(iii) take advantage of unanticipated opportunities, including more rapid
international expansion, acquisitions of customer bases or businesses or
investments in, or strategic alliances with, companies that are complementary to
the Company's current operations, (iv) develop or expand into new services, such
as CLEC, or (v) otherwise respond to unanticipated competitive pressures. The
Company currently expects to obtain any such additional capital through debt
offerings and internally generated cash flow. There can be no assurance,
however, that the Company will be successful in producing sufficient internally
generated cash flow or raising sufficient capital on terms acceptable to the
Company, if at all. Moreover, the amount of, and the terms and conditions of the
instruments relating to, the Company's current outstanding indebtedness may
adversely affect the Company's ability to raise additional capital. Failure to
internally generate or raise sufficient funds may require the Company to delay,
abandon or reduce the scope of any potential future expansion, which could have
a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operation -- Liquidity and Capital Resources."
 
                                       10
<PAGE>   14
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH MANAGEMENT OF GROWTH AND IMPLEMENTATION OF GROWTH STRATEGY
 
     The Company's rapid growth has placed, and is expected to continue to
place, a significant strain on the Company's administrative, operational and
financial resources and has increased demands on its systems and controls. There
can be no assurance, however, that the Company will be able to successfully add
services or expand its geographic markets or that existing regulatory barriers
to its current or future operations will be reduced or eliminated. For example,
the introduction of one of the Company's services, ViaCALL Plus, was delayed due
to greater than expected software development efforts required to accommodate
the many national variants of Integrated Services Digital Network ("ISDN"), a
prerequisite for the ViaCALL Plus service, and delays in obtaining regulatory
approval of the Company's switching equipment. As the Company increases its
services and expands its geographic markets, there will be additional demands on
the Company's customer support, sales and marketing and administrative resources
and network infrastructure. There can be no assurance that the Company's
administrative, operating and financial control systems and infrastructure will
be adequate to maintain and effectively monitor future growth or that the
Company will be able to successfully attract, train and manage additional
employees. The failure to continue to upgrade the Company's administrative,
operating and financial control systems and infrastructure or the occurrence of
unexpected expansion difficulties could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"-- Potential Difficulties Associated With Implementing European Expansion
Strategy" and "-- Dependence on Effective Information Systems."
 
COMPETITION
 
     The international telecommunications industry is highly competitive. The
Company's success depends upon its ability to compete with a variety of other
telecommunications providers in each of its markets, including the respective
ITO in each country in which the Company operates and global alliances among
some of the world's largest telecommunications carriers. Other potential
competitors include cable television companies, wireless telephone companies,
electric and other utilities with rights of way, railways, microwave carriers
and large end users which have private networks. The intensity of such
competition has recently increased and the Company believes that such
competition will continue to intensify as the number of new entrants increases.
Many of the Company's current or potential competitors have substantially
greater financial, marketing and other resources than the Company. If the
Company's competitors devote significant additional resources to the provision
of international or national long distance telecommunications services to the
Company's target customer base of small and medium-sized businesses, such action
could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations, and there can be no assurance that the
Company will be able to compete successfully against such new or existing
competitors.
 
     Competition for customers in the telecommunications industry is primarily
based on price and, to a lesser extent, on the type and quality of services
offered. The Company prices its services primarily by offering discounts to the
prices charged by its competitors. The Company has no control over the prices
set by its competitors, and some of the Company's competitors may be able to use
their financial resources to cause severe price competition in the countries in
which the Company operates. Although the Company does not believe that there is
an economic incentive for its competitors to pursue such a pricing strategy or
that its competitors are likely to engage in such a course of action, there can
be no assurance that severe price competition will not occur. Any such price
competition would have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. Additionally, intensified
competition in certain of the Company's markets will cause the Company to
continue to reduce its prices. For example, the Company recently reduced certain
rates which it charges to end users in response to pricing reductions enacted by
certain ITOs. Such price reductions may reduce the Company's revenue and
margins. The Company has experienced, and expects to continue to experience,
declining revenue per billable minute in all of its markets in part as a result
of increasing worldwide competition within the telecommunications industry.
 
                                       11
<PAGE>   15
 
     The Company believes that the ITOs generally have certain competitive
advantages due to their control over local connectivity and apparent close ties
with national regulatory authorities. The Company also believes that, in certain
instances, some regulators have shown a reluctance to adopt policies and grant
regulatory approvals that would result in increased competition for the local
ITO. Moreover, the Company believes that it has encountered anti-competitive
behavior on the part of certain ITOs. If the Company encounters anti-competitive
behavior in countries in which it operates or if the ITO in any country in which
the Company operates uses its competitive advantages to the fullest extent, the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations could be
materially adversely affected.
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERNATIONAL OPERATIONS
 
     There are certain risks inherent in doing business on an international
level, including regulatory limitations restricting or prohibiting the provision
of the Company's services, unexpected changes in regulatory requirements,
tariffs, customs, duties and other trade barriers, difficulties in staffing and
managing foreign operations, longer payment cycles, problems in collecting
accounts receivable, political risks, fluctuations in currency exchange rates,
foreign exchange controls which restrict or prohibit repatriation of funds,
technology export and import restrictions or prohibitions, delays from customs
brokers or government agencies, seasonal reductions in business activity during
the summer months in Europe and certain other parts of the world and potentially
adverse tax consequences resulting from operating in multiple jurisdictions with
different tax laws. For example, regulatory limitations restricting or
prohibiting the Company's operations in Latin America, including regulations in
certain countries prohibiting the provision of services through the automatic
callback access method utilized by the Company, have contributed to the
Company's decision to discontinue or modify certain of its services in such
countries. Existing or future regulations in other countries could also have
similar consequences.
 
     Since its inception in 1991, the Company has invested heavily in developing
its ability to provide international telecommunications services within Western
Europe and other deregulating markets and in developing and expanding its market
presence including, more recently, entering into the national long distance
telecommunications markets in certain EU member states. If the Company's
operations in Western Europe expand as expected, an increasing portion of the
Company's revenue and expenses will be denominated in currencies other than U.S.
dollars, and changes in exchange rates will likely affect the Company's results
of operations. Furthermore, international rates charged to customers are likely
to decrease in the future for a variety of reasons, including increased
competition between existing carriers, new entrants into geographic markets in
which the Company operates or intends to operate and additional strategic
alliances or joint ventures among large international carriers that facilitate
targeted pricing and cost reductions. Depending on the countries involved, any
or all of the foregoing factors could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition,
there can be no assurance that laws or administrative practices relating to
taxation, foreign exchange or other matters in countries within which the
Company operates will not change. Any such change could have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
See "-- Substantial Government Regulation," "-- Competition," "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations -- Liquidity and Capital Resources -- Foreign Currency," and
"Business -- Government Regulation."
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH ACQUISITIONS, INVESTMENTS AND STRATEGIC ALLIANCES
 
     The Company may, in the future, acquire or engage in efforts to acquire
customer bases and businesses from, make investments in, or enter into strategic
alliances with, companies which have customer bases, switching capabilities or
existing networks in the Company's current markets or in areas into which the
Company intends to expand the Viatel Network, generally, and the European
Network, specifically. Although the Company is currently evaluating several
potential investment opportunities, it does not have any present understanding,
commitment or agreement with respect to any acquisition, investment, strategic
alliance or related effort (other than a joint venture with Global
Telecommunication Solutions, Inc. with respect to the Company's marketing of its
proposed ViaCARD services). Any future
 
                                       12
<PAGE>   16
 
acquisitions, investments, strategic alliances or related efforts will be
accompanied by the risks commonly encountered in such transactions or efforts.
Such risks include, among others, the difficulty of identifying appropriate
acquisition candidates, the difficulty of assimilating the operations and
personnel of the respective entities, the potential disruption of the Company's
ongoing business, the inability of management to capitalize on the opportunities
presented by acquisitions, investments, strategic alliances or related efforts,
the failure to successfully incorporate licensed or acquired technology and
rights into the Company's services, the inability to maintain uniform standards,
controls, procedures and policies and the impairment of relationships with
employees and customers as a result of changes in management. Additionally, in
connection with an acquisition, the Company may experience rates of customer
attrition which are significantly higher than the rate of customer attrition
which it generally experiences. Further, to the extent that any such transaction
involves customer bases or businesses located outside the United States, the
transaction would involve the risks associated with international operations.
There can be no assurance that the Company would be successful in overcoming
these risks or any other problems encountered with such acquisitions,
investments, strategic alliances or related efforts. See "-- Potential
Difficulties Associated With Implementing European Expansion Strategy,"
"-- Risks Associated with International Operations" and "Business -- Business
Strategy -- Pursue Acquisitions, Investments and Strategic Alliances."
 
RAPID CHANGES IN TECHNOLOGY AND CUSTOMER REQUIREMENTS
 
     The telecommunications industry is characterized by rapid and significant
technological advancements and introductions of new products and services
utilizing new technologies. As new technologies develop, the Company may be
placed at a competitive disadvantage, and competitive pressures may force the
Company to implement such new technologies at substantial cost. In addition,
competitors may implement new technologies before the Company is able to
implement such technologies, allowing such competitors to provide enhanced
services and superior quality compared with that which the Company is able to
provide. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to respond to
such competitive pressures and implement such technologies on a timely basis or
at an acceptable cost. One or more of the technologies currently utilized by the
Company or, which it may implement in the future, may not be preferred by its
customers or may become obsolete. If the Company is unable to respond to
competitive pressures, implement new technologies on a timely basis, penetrate
new markets in a timely manner in response to changing market conditions or
customer requirements, or if new or enhanced services offered by the Company do
not achieve a significant degree of market acceptance, any such event could have
a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations.
 
DEPENDENCE ON EFFECTIVE INFORMATION SYSTEMS
 
     To efficiently produce customer bills in a timely manner, the Company must
record and process millions of call detail records quickly and accurately. While
the Company believes that its billing and information systems are currently
sufficient for its operations, such systems will require enhancements and
ongoing investments. There can be no assurance that the Company will not
encounter difficulties in enhancing its systems or integrating new technology
into its systems. The inability of the Company to implement any required system
enhancement, to acquire new systems or to integrate new technology in a timely
and cost effective manner could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. See
"Business -- Business Strategy -- Leverage Information Systems" and
"Business -- Information Systems."
 
VARIABILITY OF OPERATING RESULTS
 
     The Company's quarterly operating results have fluctuated in the past and
may fluctuate significantly in the future as a result of a variety of factors,
including: (i) pricing changes; (ii) changes in the mix of services sold or
channels through which those services are sold; (iii) changes in user demand,
customer terminations of service, capital expenditures and other costs relating
to the expansion of the Viatel Network; (iv) the timing and costs of any
acquisitions of customer bases and businesses, services or technologies; (v) the
timing and costs of marketing and advertising efforts; (vi) the effects of
government regulation and regulatory changes; and (vii) specific economic
conditions in the telecommunications industry. Such variability could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business,
 
                                       13
<PAGE>   17
 
financial condition and results of operations. Any significant shortfall in
demand for the Company's services in relation to the Company's expectations, or
the occurrence of any other factor which causes revenue to fall significantly
short of the Company's expectations, would also have a material adverse effect
on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. In
addition, the uncertainty of revenue growth coupled with substantial planned
increases in operating expenses and the continued evolution in the Company's
transmission methodology from switchless resale to use of the Viatel Network may
result in substantial quarterly fluctuations in the Company's operating results
which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. See "-- Limited Operating History;
Substantial Net Losses and Negative Cash Flow from Operations," "Selected
Consolidated Financial and Other Data" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
RELIANCE ON THIRD PARTIES FOR LEASED CAPACITY
 
     The Company does not currently own any telecommunications transmission
lines. As a result, the Company depends upon facilities-based carriers, some of
which are or may become competitors of the Company, to provide its services. The
Company currently leases transmission lines from, among others, British
Telecommunications, Plc, Cable & Wireless International, Inc., Mercury
Communications Ltd. and the respective ITO in each country in which the Company
conducts its Western European operations. The Company's profitability depends,
in part, on its ability to obtain and utilize leased capacity on a cost-
effective basis. The Company leases capacity pursuant to agreements with
twelve-month terms and is vulnerable to changes in its lease arrangements, such
as price increases and service cancellations. Although the Company believes that
it has and will continue to enjoy favorable arrangements with the
facilities-based carriers from which it leases transmission lines, there can be
no assurance that such arrangements will continue or that leased capacity will
continue to be available at cost-effective rates. See "Business -- The Viatel
Network" and "Business -- Carrier Contracts."
 
CONTROL BY PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS
 
     Upon completion of the Offerings, Martin Varsavsky, the Company's President
and Chief Executive Officer, COMSAT Investments, Inc. ("COMSAT"), S-C V-Tel
Investments, L.P. ("S-C V-Tel") and Juan Manuel Aisemberg, a person related by
marriage to Mr. Varsavsky, will control, in the aggregate, approximately   % of
the then outstanding shares of Common Stock on a fully diluted basis
(approximately   % if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in
full) and Mr. Varsavsky will individually beneficially own approximately   % of
the then outstanding shares of Common Stock on a fully diluted basis
(approximately   % if the Underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised in
full). These stockholders, acting pursuant to a shareholders' agreement and a
voting agreement, effectively will have the ability to control the election of
all members of the Company's Board of Directors, the outcome of most matters
submitted to a vote of the holders of Common Stock and generally will be able to
direct the affairs of the Company. Such concentration of ownership may have the
effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a change in control of the Company.
See "Management -- Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation
- -- Shareholders Agreements," "Management -- Compensation Committee Interlocks
and Insider Participation -- Voting Agreement" and "Principal Stockholders."
 
DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL
 
     The success of the Company's business will depend, to a significant extent,
upon the abilities and continued efforts of its senior management, and
particularly upon the abilities and efforts of Mr. Varsavsky and Michael J.
Mahoney, the Company's Executive Vice President, Operations and Technology. The
Company does not have employment or similar agreements with any executive
officer other than Messrs. Varsavsky and Mahoney. The term of Mr. Varsavsky's
employment agreement extends until the earlier of (i) April 4, 1997, (ii) the
date on which neither COMSAT nor S-C V-Tel beneficially owns at least 10.0%
(subject to certain adjustments) of the issued and outstanding shares of Common
Stock on a fully diluted basis and (iii) the agreement's termination in
accordance with its terms. Mr. Mahoney's employment is guaranteed through
September 30, 1996. Except for a $3.0 million "key man" life insurance policy
which the Company maintains on the life of Mr. Varsavsky, the Company does not
 
                                       14
<PAGE>   18
 
maintain nor is it currently contemplating obtaining "key man" life insurance
policies on any of its employees. The Company's success also will depend on its
ability to attract, retain and motivate qualified management, marketing,
technical and sales executives and other personnel who are in high demand and
are often subject to competing employment opportunities. The loss of the
services of key management personnel, or the inability to attract additional
qualified personnel, could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. There can be no
assurance that the Company will be successful in attracting, retaining and
motivating such executives and personnel. See "Management -- Directors and
Executive Officers" and "Management -- Employment, Expatriate and Severance
Agreements." Currently, no member of management, except for Messrs. Varsavsky
and Mahoney, own shares of Common Stock. However, certain members of management
have been granted options to acquire shares of Common Stock, which options are
subject to vesting criteria. See "Management -- Stock Incentive Plan" and
"Principal Stockholders."
 
ABSENCE OF PRIOR PUBLIC MARKET; POSSIBLE VOLATILITY OF STOCK PRICE
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock and, although the Company intends to have the Common Stock quoted on the
Nasdaq National Market, there can be no assurance that an active trading market
will develop or be maintained following the Offerings. The initial public
offering price of the Common Stock will be determined by negotiation between the
Company and the representatives of the Underwriters (as defined herein) and may
bear no relationship to the price at which the Common Stock will trade after
completion of the Offerings. For factors to be considered in determining the
initial public offering price see "Underwriting." After completion of the
Offerings, the market price of the Common Stock will be subject to fluctuations
in response to various factors and events, including the liquidity of the market
for the Common Stock, variations in the Company's quarterly operating results,
regulatory or other changes, both domestic and international, affecting the
telecommunications industry generally or the Company specifically, announcements
of business developments by the Company or its competitors, changes in operating
results and changes in general market conditions. See "-- Limited Operating
History; Substantial Net Losses and Negative Cash Flow from Operations" and
"-- Variability of Operating Results."
 
BROAD DISCRETION OVER USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     Approximately $46.8 million, or 43.3%, of the estimated net proceeds of the
Offerings has been allocated for general corporate and working capital purposes,
including up to approximately $1.0 million for feasibility studies of the
Company's provision of CLEC services. Due to the number and variability of
factors that will be analyzed before the Company determines how to use such net
proceeds, the Company will have broad discretion in allocating a significant
portion of the net proceeds from the Offerings without any action or approval of
the Company's stockholders. Accordingly, investors will not have the opportunity
to evaluate the economic, financial and other relevant information which will be
considered by the Company in determining the application of such net proceeds.
See "Use of Proceeds."
 
NET OPERATING LOSS CARRYFORWARDS
 
     As of March 31, 1996, the Company had United States federal income tax net
operating loss ("NOL") carryforwards of $43.8 million. Such NOL carryforwards
begin to expire in the year 2007.
 
     As a result of an "ownership change," as defined by Section 382 of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), triggered by the
Company's $75 million unit offering in December 1994 (the "Unit Offering"),
approximately $18 million of the Company's NOL carryforwards from periods before
the Unit Offering are subject to annual limitations. Section 382 of the Code
imposes limitations with respect to the carryforward of NOLs by a corporation
that experiences a more-than-50-percent ownership change over a three-year
testing period (or over a shorter period if there has been a prior ownership
change within the immediately preceding three-year period). In general, if such
an ownership change occurs, Section 382 of the Code limits the amount of the
NOLs carried over from pre-ownership change years that can be used in any
post-change year to an amount equal to the product obtained by multiplying (1)
the value of the corporation's capital stock (with certain adjustments) at the
time of the change and (2) an interest rate determined by the Internal Revenue
Service for the month of the change.
 
                                       15
<PAGE>   19
 
     The Company does not believe that the Offerings will result in a
more-than-50-percent ownership change. If, however, after the completion of the
Offerings, additional direct or indirect changes in the ownership of the
Company's capital stock occurs within the relevent testing period, such changes
could, when considered together with the Offerings, result in a
more-than-50-percent ownership change and substantially restrict the Company's
subsequent use of its then unutilized NOL carryforwards.
 
     The Company will be required to pay federal income tax in any year in which
its taxable income exceeds the amount of each of the NOL carryforwards limited
by Section 382 of the Code plus the aggregate NOL carryforwards from years after
the ownership change. To the extent the Company does not use the full amount of
its limited NOL carryforward in any year, such unused portion can be used to
increase the NOL carryforwards limitation for subsequent years prior to the
expiration of the NOL carryforwards subject to the limitation.
 
IMMEDIATE AND SUBSTANTIAL DILUTION
 
     At an assumed initial public offering price of $          per share of
Common Stock, and after giving effect to the conversion of all outstanding
shares of Class A Common Stock into shares of Common Stock, purchasers of Common
Stock in the Offerings will experience immediate and substantial dilution of
$          per share in net tangible book value per share of outstanding Common
Stock. See "Dilution."
 
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
     Future sales of Common Stock by existing stockholders under Rule 144 ("Rule
144") of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), through
the exercise of outstanding registration rights or otherwise, could have an
adverse effect on the market price of the Common Stock and the ability of the
Company to raise capital in the future. The shares of Common Stock sold in the
Offerings will be eligible for immediate resale, except to the extent acquired
by affiliates of the Company. Additionally, 1,386,878 shares of Common Stock
which are "restricted securities," as that term is defined in Rule 144, owned by
persons who are not affiliates of the Company are currently eligible for sale
under Rule 144. Upon the expiration or waiver of certain lock-up agreements with
the Underwriters, approximately            additional shares of Common Stock
will be eligible for sale in the public market pursuant to Rule 144. Pursuant to
lock-up agreements with the Underwriters, each of Messrs. Varsavsky and
Aisemberg, COMSAT and S-C V-Tel, as well as certain other directors and officers
of the Company, has agreed not to offer, sell or contract to sell, or otherwise
dispose of, directly or indirectly, or announce the offering of, any shares of
Common Stock, including any such shares beneficially or indirectly owned or
controlled, or any securities convertible into, or exchangeable or exercisable
for, shares of Common Stock for   days from the date of this Prospectus, without
the prior written consent of Salomon Brothers Inc. The remaining shares
outstanding upon completion of the Offerings will be eligible for sale pursuant
to Rule 144 upon the expiration of the current two-year holding period. Certain
existing stockholders have certain rights to require the Company to register a
total of 10,321,824 shares of Common Stock after expiration of the lock-up
agreements. See "Description of Capital Stock -- Registration Rights," "Shares
Eligible for Future Sale" and "Underwriting."
 
     The Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") has proposed
amendments to Rule 144 which would reduce the holding period required for shares
subject to Rule 144 to become eligible for resale on the public market. This
proposal, if adopted, would increase the number of shares of Common Stock
eligible for immediate resale following the expiration of lock-up agreements.
 
ANTI-TAKEOVER CONSIDERATIONS
 
     Prior to completion of the Offerings, the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation, as amended, and Bylaws will be amended to include certain
provisions which are intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity and
stability in the composition of the Company's Board of Directors and which may
have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a future takeover or change
in control of the Company unless such takeover or change in control is approved
by the Company's Board of Directors, even though such a transaction may offer
the holders of Common Stock the opportunity to sell such shares of Common Stock
 
                                       16
<PAGE>   20
 
at a price above the prevailing market price. Such provisions may also render
the removal of directors and management more difficult. Specifically, the
Company's Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, and Bylaws, as the case may
be, will be amended to provide for a classified Board of Directors serving
staggered three-year terms, certain restrictions on the ability of stockholders
to call a special meeting of stockholders and certain advance notice
requirements for stockholder nominations of candidates for election to the
Company's Board of Directors and certain other stockholder proposals. Such
provisions could limit the price that certain persons might be willing to pay in
the future for shares of Common Stock. In addition, prior to completion of the
Offerings, the Company's Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, will be
amended and restated to authorize the Board of Directors of the Company to issue
from time to time, without any further action of stockholders, up to 1.0 million
shares of Preferred Stock (as defined herein), on such terms and with such
rights, designations, preferences, qualifications, limitations and restrictions
as the Board of Directors may determine. Issuance of such Preferred Stock,
depending upon the rights, designations, preferences, qualifications,
limitations and restrictions thereof, may have the effect of delaying, deterring
or preventing a change in control of the Company or may otherwise adversely
affect the interests of holders of Common Stock. The issuance of Preferred
Stock, for example, could decrease the amount of earnings or assets available
for distribution to holders of Common Stock or could adversely affect the rights
and powers, including voting rights, of the holders of the Common Stock.
Further, certain provisions of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the "DGCL")
prevent certain stockholders from engaging in business combinations with the
Company, subject to certain exceptions. See "Description of Capital
Stock -- Preferred Stock," "Description of Capital Stock -- Certain Provisions
of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws and Indenture" and
"Description of Capital Stock -- Delaware Anti-Takeover Law."
 
     The Indenture dated as of December 15, 1994 (the "Indenture") between the
Company and United States Trust Company of New York, as Trustee, relating to the
Company's 15.0% Senior Discount Notes due 2005 (the "Notes"), provides that upon
the occurrence of a "Change of Control" (as defined herein) the Company will be
required to make an offer (a "Change of Control Offer") to purchase all of the
Notes issued and then outstanding under the Indenture at a purchase price equal
to 101.0% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest
thereon, if any, to the date of purchase. The Notes currently outstanding have
an aggregate principal amount of $120.7 million. There can be no assurance that,
in the event of a Change of Control, the Company will have, or will have access
to, sufficient funds to repurchase the Notes. See "Description of Capital
Stock -- Certain Provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation,
Bylaws and Indenture." In addition, Mr. Mahoney's expatriate agreement contains
provisions which require the Company to make certain payments to Mr. Mahoney in
the event he is terminated in connection with a "change of control" (as defined
herein). See "Management -- Employment, Expatriate and Severance Agreements."
Further, the Stock Incentive Plan provides that outstanding options, restricted
stock or Stock Appreciation Rights ("SARs") vest in their entirety and become
exercisable or, with respect to restricted stock, are released from restrictions
on transfer and repurchase rights in the event of a "Corporate Transaction" (as
herein defined). See "Management -- Stock Incentive Plan." The Indenture,
expatriate agreement and Stock Incentive Plan provisions may have the effect of
delaying, deterring or preventing a change of control of the Company, may
discourage bids for outstanding shares of Common Stock and may adversely affect
the market price of the Common Stock.
 
                                       17
<PAGE>   21
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds of the Offerings are estimated to be approximately $108.0
million (approximately $124.4 million if the Underwriters' over-allotment option
is exercised in full) after deducting estimated expenses of the Offerings
payable by the Company. The Company estimates that it will use approximately (i)
$32.2 million of the net proceeds of the Offerings for network upgrade and
expansion, including the purchase and installation of POPs or switches to expand
the European Network from nine to up to 48 Western European cities, the
installation of a POP in Miami and a switch in Los Angeles and for the upgrade
of the Company's switch in London and its New York City POP to a switch, (ii)
$9.0 million for investments in digital undersea fiber optic cable, (iii) $20.0
million for acquisitions of customer bases and businesses or for investment in
joint ventures or strategic alliances, and (iv) $46.8 million for general
corporate and working capital purposes, including up to approximately $1.0
million for feasibility studies of the Company's provision of CLEC services. See
"Risk Factors -- Substantial Capital Requirements."
 
     There can be no assurance that the Company's actual application of the
proceeds will not vary substantially from the Company's current plans. See "Risk
Factors -- Broad Discretion Over Use of Proceeds." Moreover, the Company will
need additional capital to (i) finance its anticipated growth, (ii) fund working
capital needs and future debt service obligations, (iii) take advantage of
unanticipated opportunities, including more rapid international expansion,
acquisitions of customer bases or businesses or investments in, or strategic
alliances with, companies that are complementary to the Company's current
operations, (iv) develop or expand into new services, such as CLEC, or (v)
otherwise respond to unanticipated competitive pressures. See "Risk
Factors -- Substantial Capital Requirements," "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated
With Management of Growth and Implementation of Growth Strategy," "Risk
Factors -- Risks Associated with International Operations," "Risk
Factors -- Risks Associated with Acquisitions, Investments and Strategic
Alliances" and "Business -- Business Strategy."
 
     Although the Company is currently evaluating several potential investment
opportunities, it does not have any present understanding, commitment or
agreement with respect to any acquisition, investment, strategic alliance or
related effort (other than a joint venture with Global Telecommunication
Solutions, Inc. with respect to the Company's marketing of its proposed ViaCARD
services).
 
     Pending application of the net proceeds of the Offerings, the Company
expects that it will place such net proceeds in interest-bearing bank accounts
or invest such proceeds in United States government securities or other
short-term, interest bearing, investment grade securities. The Company is not
currently, and does not expect as a result of the Offerings to become, subject
to the registration requirements of the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the
"1940 Act"). If the Company were required to register as an investment company
under the 1940 Act, it would become subject to substantial regulations with
respect to its capital structure, management, operations, transactions with
affiliates (as defined in the 1940 Act), and other matters. Application of the
provisions of the 1940 Act would have a material adverse effect on the Company.
 
                                DIVIDEND POLICY
 
     The Company has never declared or paid any cash dividends on its Common
Stock and does not expect to do so in the foreseeable future. The Company
anticipates that all future earnings, if any, generated from operations will be
retained to finance the expansion and continued development of its business. Any
future determination with respect to the payment of dividends will be within the
sole discretion of the Company's Board of Directors and will depend upon, among
other things, the Company's earnings, capital requirements, the terms of then
existing indebtedness, applicable requirements of the DGCL, general economic
conditions and such other factors considered relevant by the Company's Board of
Directors. In addition, the Company's ability to pay cash dividends is
restricted under the terms of the Indenture unless certain financial tests are
met.
 
                                       18
<PAGE>   22
 
                                    DILUTION
 
     The Company's pro forma net tangible book value as of March 31, 1996 was
approximately ($          ) million, or approximately ($          ) per share of
outstanding Common Stock (after giving effect to the conversion of all
outstanding shares of Class A Common Stock). Net tangible book value per share
of Common Stock represents the total amount of tangible assets of the Company,
less the total amount of liabilities of the Company, divided by the number of
shares of Common Stock outstanding on a fully diluted basis. After giving effect
to the sale by the Company of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby and
assuming no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option, less estimated
underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated expenses of the Offerings
payable by the Company, and the application of the estimated net proceeds
therefrom, the Company's pro forma net tangible book value as of March 31, 1996
would have been approximately $     million, or approximately $          per
share of Common Stock. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible
book value of approximately $          per share of Common Stock to existing
stockholders and an immediate dilution in net tangible book value of
approximately $          per share of Common Stock to new investors purchasing
shares of Common Stock in the Offerings. The following table illustrates this
dilution on a per share basis to the new investors:
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                            <C>        <C>
     Assumed initial public offering price per share..............             $
          Pro forma net tangible book value per share at March 31,
            1996..................................................  ($      )
          Increase in net tangible book value per share
            attributable to net proceeds of the Offerings.........
                                                                       -----
     Pro forma net tangible book value per share after giving
       effect to the Offerings....................................
                                                                                  -----
     Dilution per share to new investors..........................             $
                                                                                  =====
</TABLE>
 
     The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis as of March 31, 1996,
the number of shares of Common Stock purchased from the Company, the total
consideration paid to the Company and the average price per share of Common
Stock paid by existing stockholders and by new investors before deducting the
estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated expenses of the
Offerings payable by the Company:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    TOTAL
                                        SHARES PURCHASED        CONSIDERATION         AVERAGE
                                       ------------------     ------------------       PRICE
                                       NUMBER     PERCENT     AMOUNT     PERCENT     PER SHARE
                                       -------    -------     ------     -------     ---------
     <S>                               <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>
     Existing stockholders..........                     %    $                 %    $
     New investors..................                     %                      %
                                         -----      -----
       Total........................                     %    $                 %
                                         =====      =====
</TABLE>
 
     The above tables assume conversion of all outstanding shares of Class A
Common Stock into shares of Common Stock, the exercise of outstanding options to
purchase 1,302,949 shares of Common Stock at exercise prices ranging from $.50
to $3.90 and no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option. See
"Management -- Stock Incentive Plan" and "Capitalization."
 
                                       19
<PAGE>   23
 
                                 CAPITALIZATION
 
     The following table sets forth as of March 31, 1996, the actual
capitalization of the Company and the capitalization of the Company at such date
after giving effect to the conversion of all outstanding shares of Class A
Common Stock into shares of Common Stock, the issuance of the shares of Common
Stock offered hereby, at an assumed initial public offering price of $
per share of Common Stock, and the application of the estimated net proceeds
from the Offerings as described in "Use of Proceeds." This table should be read
in conjunction with the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements, including
the Notes thereto, and the other financial data included elsewhere in this
Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       AS OF MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                  ------------------------------
                                                                   ACTUAL         AS ADJUSTED
                                                                  ---------    -----------------
<S>                                                               <C>          <C>
                                                                          (IN THOUSANDS)
Cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities...............   $  23,082        $
                                                                   ========         ========
Long-term debt.................................................   $  69,791        $
                                                                   ========         ========
Stockholders' (deficit) equity:
     Common Stock, $.01 par value; 50,000,000 shares
       authorized, 16,104,202 shares issued and outstanding;
                 shares issued and outstanding, as
       adjusted(1).............................................         161
     Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value; 10,000,000 shares
       authorized, 4,357,270 shares issued and outstanding; no
       shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding, as
       adjusted................................................          44               --
     Preferred Stock, $.01 par value; no shares authorized, no
       shares issued and outstanding; 1,000,000 shares
       authorized, no shares issued and outstanding, as
       adjusted................................................          --               --
     Additional paid-in capital................................      30,031
     Unearned compensation.....................................         (68)
     Cumulative translation adjustment.........................         (68)
     Accumulated deficit.......................................     (56,738)
                                                                   --------         --------
          Total stockholders' (deficit) equity.................     (26,638)
                                                                   --------         --------
          Total capitalization.................................   $  66,235        $
                                                                   ========         ========
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Excludes (i) 1,750,000 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under
    the Stock Incentive Plan of which options to purchase 1,294,078 shares of
    Common Stock, exercisable at prices ranging from $.50 to $3.90 per share,
    have been granted and are outstanding on the date hereof and (ii) 8,871
    other outstanding options to purchase shares of Common Stock, exercisable at
    $.50 per share. See "Management -- Stock Incentive Plan."
 
                                       20
<PAGE>   24
 
                 SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA
     The following selected Consolidated Statement of Operations Data, Other
Financial Data and Balance Sheet Data as of and for the years ended December 31,
1995, 1994, 1993 and 1992 have been derived from the Consolidated Financial
Statements of the Company and the Notes related thereto, included elsewhere in
this Prospectus, which were audited by KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent
Certified Public Accountants, for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and
1993 and by Edward Isaacs & Company LLP, independent Certified Public
Accountants, for the year ended December 31, 1992. The selected Statement of
Operations Data, Other Financial Data and Balance Sheet Data as of and for the
eleven-month period ended December 31, 1991 have been derived from the unaudited
Financial Statements of the Company which, in the opinion of management, include
all adjustments necessary for a fair presentation of the financial condition and
results of operations for the Company for such period. The selected consolidated
Statement of Operations Data, Other Financial Data and Balance Sheet Data as of
and for the three-month periods ended March 31, 1996 and 1995 have been derived
from the unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company included
elsewhere in this Prospectus, which, in the opinion of management, include all
adjustments necessary for a fair presentation of the financial condition and
results of operations of the Company for such periods. The results of operations
for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of a full year's operations.
This information should be read in conjunction with "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," the Company's
Consolidated Financial Statements, including the Notes thereto, and the other
financial data included elsewhere in this Prospectus.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                          ELEVEN
                                            THREE MONTHS                                                                  MONTHS
                                           ENDED MARCH 31,                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                    ENDED
                                        ---------------------    ---------------------------------------------------     DEC. 31,
                                          1996         1995        1995          1994          1993          1992          1991
                                        --------     --------    ---------     ---------     ---------     ---------     --------
<S>                                     <C>          <C>         <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
                                             (UNAUDITED)
 
<CAPTION>
                                                             (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT OTHER OPERATING DATA)(1)
<S>                                     <C>          <C>         <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
  Telecommunications revenue........... $ 10,590     $  6,929    $  32,313     $  26,268     $  21,393     $   6,701      $  268
  Operating expenses:
    Cost of telecommunications
      services.........................    8,999        5,900       27,648        22,953        18,159         5,462         260
    Selling expenses...................    2,401        1,537        7,468         4,459         2,389           895          39
    General and administrative
      expense..........................    5,129        2,903       16,860         9,859         6,069         1,610          58
    Depreciation and amortization......    1,088          499        2,637           789           111            15           5
    Equipment impairment loss..........       --           --          560            --            --            --          --
                                           -----     --------     --------     ---------     ---------      --------     --------
      Total operating expenses.........   17,617       10,839       55,173        38,060        26,728         7,982         362
                                           -----     --------     --------     ---------     ---------      --------     --------
  Operating loss....................... $ (7,027)    $ (3,909)   $ (22,860)    $ (11,792)    $  (5,335)    $  (1,281)     $  (94)
  Interest income (expense), net.......   (2,099)      (1,053)      (5,574)         (558)           21            (8)         --
  Share in loss of affiliate...........       (1)         (12)         (42)         (145)         (142)           --          --
                                           -----     --------     --------     ---------     ---------      --------     --------
  Net loss............................. $ (9,127)    $ (4,974)   $ (28,476)    $ (12,495)    $  (5,456)    $  (1,289)     $  (94)
                                           =====     ========     ========     =========     =========      ========     ========
  Net loss per share(2)................ $                        $
OTHER FINANCIAL DATA:
  EBITDA(3)............................ $ (5,939)    $ (3,410)   $ (20,223)    $ (11,003)    $  (5,224)    $  (1,266)     $  (89)
  Capital expenditures, including
    acquisitions of businesses......... $  3,227     $  3,134    $  11,378     $   4,843     $   2,643     $      70      $    2
OTHER OPERATING DATA(4):
  Billable minutes (000's) (5)(6)......   10,866        4,603       25,932        14,981        10,899         3,097
  Average revenue per billable
    minute(6)(7)....................... $   0.95     $   1.50    $    1.23     $    1.70     $    1.87     $    2.16
  Average cost per billable
    minute(6)(8)....................... $   0.78     $   1.28    $    1.04     $    1.53     $    1.67     $    1.76
  Switches(6)(9)(10)...................       11            2           10             2             2
  Customers(6)(10).....................   11,363        6,922        9,218         6,469         5,486
BALANCE SHEET DATA(10):
  Working capital...................... $ 18,146     $ 33,238    $  26,214     $  58,549     $  (3,628)    $  (1,219)     $  (44)
  Property and equipment, net..........   17,590        9,821       15,715         6,933         3,584            62           2
  Total assets.........................   57,483       77,629       65,613        83,923        10,585         2,147         161
  Long-term debt, excluding current
    installments.......................   69,791       61,388       67,283        59,955           866            --          --
  Stockholders' (deficit) equity(11)...  (26,638)       5,979      (17,618)       10,985          (162)       (1,139)        (19)
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 (1) Amounts presented may not total due to rounding.
 (2) Net loss per share is computed on the basis described in Note 1 of the
     Company's Consolidated Financial Statements, except that such data has been
     computed to give effect to the conversion of the Class A Common Stock.
 (3) As used herein, "EBITDA" consists of earnings before interest (net), income
     taxes, depreciation and amortization and share in loss of affiliate. EBITDA
     is a measure commonly used in the telecommunications industry to analyze
     companies on the basis of operating performance. EBITDA is not a measure of
     financial performance under generally accepted accounting principles and
     should not be considered as an alternative to net income as a measure of
     performance nor as an alternative to cash flow as a measure of liquidity.
 (4) Information derived from operating records prepared by the Company.
 (5) Billable minutes are those minutes during which a call is connected at any
     Company switch and for which the Company bills a customer.
 (6) Blanks indicate that data is not available for such period.
 (7) Represents the gross call usage revenue per billable minute. Amounts
     exclude other revenue and revenue related items such as hardware sales,
     software licensing, credits, discounts and other non-usage charges.
 (8) Represents the cost associated with the Company's provision of
     telecommunications services per billable minute. Amounts exclude
     nontransmission costs such as hardware and software purchased for resale.
 (9) For the three months ended March 31, 1996 and the year ended December 31,
     1995, includes two switches at the Omaha, Nebraska switching center and one
     switch at each of the Company's other switching sites.
(10) Information presented as of the end of the period indicated.
(11) The Company has never paid cash dividends on its Common Stock.
 
                                       21
<PAGE>   25
 
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following is a discussion of the financial condition and results of
operations of the Company for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and 1995 and
the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993. This discussion should be read
in conjunction with the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements, including
the Notes related thereto, and the other financial data included elsewhere in
this Prospectus.
 
OVERVIEW
 
     Since its inception in 1991, the Company has invested heavily in developing
its ability to provide international telecommunications services within Western
Europe and other deregulating markets and in developing and expanding its market
presence including, more recently, entering into the national long distance
telecommunications markets in certain EU member states. During the past five
years, the Company has made substantial investments in software and back office
operations, an administrative infrastructure and a direct sales organization in
Western Europe. Furthermore, the Company has created an extensive commercial
telecommunications network for voice and voice band data in Europe, which the
Company believes is necessary to effectively render the services it currently
offers and intends to offer after the liberalization of regulations relating to
Voice Telephony. Consequently, the Company has incurred a high level of expense
in connection with its inception and its continued expansion which has resulted
in net operating losses since its inception.
 
     During the past two years, several key trends have affected the composition
of the Company's telecommunications revenue, which is derived principally from
the number of minutes of use billed by the Company, or "billable minutes."
First, a growing proportion of the Company's customers, particularly in Western
Europe, now access the Viatel Network using paid local access through the PSTN
rather than paid access through the Company using callback or ITF. This change
has had a negative impact on the Company's revenue per minute. Second, the
Company expanded its wholesale business, which represented approximately 12.8%
and 29.4% of total telecommunications revenue and billable minutes,
respectively, for the first quarter of 1996. Third, Europe is becoming an
increasingly more important market for the Company. During the first quarter of
1996, approximately 42.5% of the Company's revenue was generated in Europe as
compared to approximately 35.9% of the Company's revenues during the first
quarter of 1995. In contrast, despite a 5.7% increase over the corresponding
period of 1995, revenue from Latin America represented approximately 29.6% of
the Company's revenue during the first quarter of 1996 as compared to
approximately 43.2% of the Company's revenue during the first quarter of 1995.
 
     Cost of telecommunications service is comprised of costs associated with
the transmission of voice and voice band data telecommunications services. The
European Network was developed to reduce the Company's costs of providing
telecommunications services and to increase customer usage. This change in
service provision has resulted in the Company's customer access methods evolving
from callback and ITF access to NTF and paid local access. Calls that are not
routed through the European Network generate significantly higher variable costs
because they are connected using relatively expensive ITF numbers or callback.
In contrast, because the Viatel Network has significant fixed costs associated
with its operations, consisting primarily of leased line rental charges, local
connectivity and facility/network management costs, calls routed through the
Viatel Network have lower variable costs than off-network traffic. Although the
current traffic volume through the European portion of the Company's network is
too low to achieve desired economies of scale, transmission costs are expected
to decline as a percentage of revenue as call traffic through the European
Network increases. See "Risk Factors -- Potential Difficulties Associated With
Implementing European Expansion Strategy" and "Business -- The Viatel Network --
The European Network."
 
                                       22
<PAGE>   26
 
     The Company's selling expenses include commissions to independent sales
representatives in countries in which the Company does not operate its own
direct sales force. The Company's general and administrative expense includes
overhead costs associated with its headquarters, back office and network
operations and Western European sales offices. The costs associated with
maintaining this management infrastructure, along with the Company's selling
expenses, are substantially higher than the gross margins currently being
generated by the Company.
 
     As a consequence of the establishment of an administrative infrastructure
for managing the business, changes in the composition of both telecommunications
revenue and transmission costs, development of the European Network and the
establishment of direct sales organizations since the Company's inception, the
Company's results of operations for the periods presented are not necessarily
comparable.
 
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following table summarizes the breakdown of the Company's results of
operations as a percentage of revenue:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 THREE MONTHS
                                                ENDED MARCH 31,      YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                ---------------     -------------------------
                                                1996      1995      1995      1994      1993
                                                -----     -----     -----     -----     -----
<S>                                             <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Telecommunications revenue....................  100.0%    100.0%    100.0%    100.0%    100.0%
Cost of telecommunications services...........   85.0      85.2      85.6      87.4      84.9
Selling expenses..............................   22.7      22.2      23.1      17.0      11.2
General and administrative expense............   48.4      41.9      52.2      37.5      28.4
Depreciation and amortization.................   10.3       7.2       8.2       3.0       0.5
</TABLE>
 
THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 COMPARED TO THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995
 
     Telecommunications Revenue.  Telecommunications revenue increased by 52.8%
to $10.6 million on 10.9 million billable minutes for the three months ended
March 31, 1996 from $6.9 million on 4.6 million billable minutes for the three
months ended March 31, 1995. Telecommunications revenue growth for the period
ended March 31, 1996 was generated primarily from higher traffic volume on the
European Network and from growth in the Company's wholesale business and, to a
lesser extent, from growth in traffic volume in Latin America and the Pacific
Rim.
 
     The overall increase in billable minutes was partially offset by declining
revenue per billable minute. Average revenue per billable minute declined by
36.0% from $1.50 in the three months ended March 31, 1995 to $.96 in the
corresponding period in 1996 primarily because of (i) a higher percentage of
lower-priced intra-European traffic from the European Network, (ii) a higher
precentage of low-priced wholesale traffic, (iii) reductions in certain rates
charged to end users in response to pricing reductions enacted by certain ITOs
and (iv) changes in customer access methods. See "-- Cost of Telecommunications
Services" and "Risk Factors -- Competition."
 
     Revenue per billable minute from the sale of services to end users
decreased to $1.17 in the three months ended March 31, 1996 from $1.57 in the
three months ended March 31, 1995. Revenue per billable minute from the sale of
services to other carriers and resellers increased to $.42 in the three months
ended March 31, 1996 from $.34 in the three months ended March 31, 1995
primarily as a result of an overall increase in intercontinental call traffic.
The number of customers billed rose 64.2% to 11,363 at March 31, 1996 from 6,922
at March 31, 1995.
 
     The Company has significantly increased its wholesale business through
which the Company sells switched minutes to carriers and other resellers at
discounted rates to utilize excess network capacity. While the wholesale
business has lower average gross margins than the Company's non-wholesale
business, the revenue generated from the wholesale business partially offsets
the fixed costs associated with the Viatel Network. The wholesale business
represented approximately 12.8% and approximately
 
                                       23
<PAGE>   27
 
29.4% of total telecommunications revenue and billable minutes, respectively,
for the three months ended March 31, 1996 as compared to 1.3% and 6.0% of total
telecommunications revenue and billable minutes, respectively, for the three
months ended March 31, 1995. While this increase represents more than a
nine-fold increase over the corresponding period for 1995, a portion of this
increase represents the migration of business formerly conducted by the Company
in Africa and the Middle East through indirect sales representatives to carriers
which purchase switched minutes from the Company. The Company does not expect
revenue generated by its wholesale business to continue to grow at this rate.
 
     Cost of Telecommunications Services.  Cost of telecommunications services
increased to $9.0 million in the three months ended March 31, 1996 from $5.9
million in the three months ended March 31, 1995 and, as a percentage of
revenue, decreased to approximately 85.0% from approximately 85.2% for the three
months ended March 31, 1996 and 1995, respectively. The Company experienced a
39.1% decrease in average cost per billable minute to $.78 during the three
months ended March 31, 1996 from $1.28 during the three months ended March 31,
1995. This decrease, which more than offset the effect of the decline in average
revenue per billable minute, was attributable primarily to (i) increased traffic
being routed through the European Network, which was used to originate
approximately 79.0% of the Company's European-related call revenue during the
three months ended March 31, 1996, (ii) an increase in switched minutes
generated by the Company's wholesale carrier business and (iii) changes in
customer access methods.
 
     Gross margins for the three months ended March 31, 1996 were negatively
impacted by increases in certain costs related to the expansion of the Company's
overall transmission capacity. These fixed costs are expected to decrease as a
percentage of revenue as traffic volume over the European Network increases. As
a result of obtaining additional international private line circuit ("IPLC")
capacity, the costs associated with the European Network increased to
approximately $.8 million for the three months ended March 31, 1996
(approximately 8.0% of revenue for such period) from approximately $.4 million
for the three months ended March 31, 1995 (approximately 5.6% of revenue for
such period). Additionally, the Company incurred costs associated with enhancing
the United States backbone (redundant fiber optic capacity at the Omaha,
Nebraska facility and a leased line between New York and Omaha) totaling
approximately $.2 million (approximately 2.0% of revenue for such period). IPLCs
represent a significant portion of the Company's fixed costs and were not fully
utilized in the three months ended March 31, 1996. The Company believes its use
of IPLCs will continue to increase and such increase will positively impact the
Company's overall gross margins, as a percentage of revenue, as more minutes are
routed through the European Network. This benefit, however, is primarily limited
to calls that either originate or terminate in a city where the Company has a
switch or POP, since otherwise the Company transports the call over the PSTN, at
higher transmission costs and reduced margins.
 
     Selling Expenses.  Selling expenses increased to $2.4 million in the three
months ended March 31, 1996 from $1.5 million in the three months ended March
31, 1995 and, as a percentage of revenue, remained relatively constant at
approximately 22.7% for the first quarter of 1996 compared to approximately
22.2% for the first quarter of 1995. Commissions paid to independent sales
representatives constituted approximately 24.0% of all selling expenses for the
three months ended March 31, 1996 compared to approximately 43.8% for the three
months ended March 31, 1995. The increase in selling expenses is attributable to
the Company's establishment of direct sales organizations. Salary related
selling expenses represented approximately 49.1% and approximately 42.3% of
total selling expenses for the three months ended March 31, 1996 and 1995,
respectively.
 
     General and Administrative Expense.  General and administrative expense
increased to $5.1 million in the three months ended March 31, 1996 from $2.9
million in the three months ended March 31, 1995 and, as a percentage of
revenue, increased to approximately 48.4% in the first quarter of 1996 from
approximately 41.9% in the first quarter of 1995. Much of this increase is
attributable to the costs of building a direct sales force in Western Europe and
overhead costs associated with the Company's headquarters, back office and
network operations.
 
                                       24
<PAGE>   28
 
     Depreciation and Amortization.  Depreciation and amortization expense,
which includes depreciation of the Viatel Network, increased to approximately
$1.1 million in the three months ended March 31, 1996 from approximately $.5
million in the three months ended March 31, 1995. The increase was due primarily
to the depreciation of switches and other equipment placed in service during
1995 and the three months ended March 31, 1996.
 
     Interest.  Interest expense increased to approximately $2.6 million in the
three months ended March 31, 1996 from approximately $2.1 million in the three
months ended March 31, 1995 due to the accretion of non-cash interest on the
Notes. No interest is payable on the Notes until July 15, 2000, at which time
semi-annual interest payments will be required through the January 15, 2005
maturity date. This expense was partially offset by interest income of
approximately $.5 million and $1.0 million for the three months ended March 31,
1996 and 1995, respectively, derived from the investment of the net proceeds
from the Unit Offering in highly liquid debt instruments.
 
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994
 
     Telecommunications Revenue.  Telecommunications revenue increased by
approximately 23.0% to $32.3 million on 25.9 million billable minutes in 1995
from $26.3 million on 15.1 million billable minutes in 1994. This growth in
telecommunications revenue resulted primarily from the use of direct sales
organizations in Europe which the Company began to establish in late 1994, the
creation of a wholesale business and growth experienced in the Company's revenue
derived from the Pacific Rim ($4.4 million in 1995 versus $2.0 million in 1994).
Part of this increase was offset by declining revenue per billable minute.
Average revenue per billable minute declined by 27.6% from $1.70 in 1994 to
$1.23 in 1995. The decrease was primarily due to a change in revenue mix, which
in 1995 included a higher percentage of lower-priced intra-European traffic
associated with the European Network becoming operational and a higher
percentage of wholesale traffic, together with a reduction in rates as a result
of the Company's response to price reductions by ITOs. The Company's wholesale
business represented approximately 6.1% of telecommunications revenue and
approximately 21.6% of billable minutes for 1995. Revenue per billable minute
from the sale of services to end users decreased from $1.72 in 1994 to $1.46 in
1995 while revenue per billable minute from the sale of services to other
carriers and resellers was $0.35 in 1995. The number of customers billed rose
approximately 42.5% to 9,218 at December 31, 1995 from 6,469 at December 31,
1994.
 
     Cost of Telecommunications Services.  Cost of telecommunications services
increased to $27.6 million in 1995 from $23.0 million in 1994 and, as a
percentage of revenue, decreased to approximately 85.6% from approximately 87.4%
for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, respectively. The corresponding
increase in gross margin was primarily attributable to changes in customer
access methods and changes in service mix attributable to the European Network
becoming operational. Accordingly, the Company experienced an approximately
32.0% decrease in average cost per billable minute to $1.04 during 1995 from
$1.53 during 1994. This decrease, which more than offset the effect of the
decline in average revenue per billable minute, was attributable to a continued
decline in U.S. international rates for outbound switched minutes and to
increased traffic volume being routed through the European Network, which was
used to originate calls accounting for approximately 58.0% of the Company's
European-related call revenue during 1995. The increased European Network
utilization helped reduce costs associated with intra-European and
intercontinental telecommunications services due to the predominantly fixed cost
nature of the European Network. On the other hand, during 1994 the Company's
gross margin was adversely affected by the delayed implementation of the
European Network. The Company had priced its services to be competitive with the
ITOs in Spain and Italy in anticipation of the European Network's becoming
operational; however, due to delays in the implementation of the European
Network, the Company realized significant losses on this traffic as a result of
having to route calls through ITF access instead of through the European
Network.
 
     Increases in certain fixed costs related to expansion of the Company's
overall transmission capacity negatively impacted the Company's gross margin for
the year ended December 31, 1995. As a result of obtaining additional IPLC
capacity, the costs associated with the European Network increased to
 
                                       25
<PAGE>   29
 
approximately $2.0 million for 1995 (approximately 6.3% of revenue for such
period) from approximately $1.1 million for 1994 (approximately 4.1% of revenue
for such period). Additionally, the Company incurred costs associated with
obtaining redundant fiber optic capacity at the Omaha, Nebraska facility
totaling approximately $.5 million (approximately 1.7% of revenue for 1995).
 
     Selling Expenses.  Selling expenses increased to $7.5 million in 1995 from
$4.5 million in 1994 and, as a percentage of revenue, increased to approximately
23.1% from approximately 17.0% for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994,
respectively. During 1994, these expenses were principally comprised of
commissions paid to independent sales representatives which constituted
approximately 75.2% of all selling expenses in comparison to approximately 31.5%
for 1995. The increase in selling expenses and change in expense structure is
attributable to the Company's strategy of establishing direct sales
organizations to take greater control over the marketing of its services and to
provide a higher level of customer service. The Company began to implement this
strategy in late 1994 and, as of December 31, 1995, had sales offices in
Belgium, France, Germany, the Netherlands, Italy and Spain. Accordingly, salary
related selling expenses increased to approximately 48.5% of total selling
expenses for 1995 in comparison to approximately 7.7% for 1994. As a percentage
of revenue, the use of direct sales organizations is more costly than the use of
independent sales organizations during the start-up phase of a sales operation.
However, the Company anticipates that selling expenses, as a percentage of
revenue, will decrease over time.
 
     General and Administrative Expense.  General and administrative expense
increased to $16.9 million in 1995 from $9.9 million in 1994 and, as a
percentage of revenue, increased to approximately 52.2% from approximately 37.5%
for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, respectively. Beginning in the
third quarter of 1994, the Company invested significant funds establishing a
physical presence in its various geographic markets in Western Europe and in
building an administrative infrastructure in its United States and Western
European offices. Such an effort entailed significant expenditures for salary,
rent, office and similar expenses.
 
     Depreciation and Amortization.  Depreciation and amortization expense,
which includes depreciation of the Viatel Network, increased to approximately
$2.6 million in 1995 from approximately $.8 million in 1994. The increase in
such expense was due primarily to the depreciation of the European Network which
became operational during October 1994 and the amortization of territorial
exclusivity rights associated with the Company's acquisition of independent
sales organizations in Italy and Barcelona, which occurred in December 1994, as
well as recognizing depreciation for additional switches and other items placed
in service during 1994 and 1995.
 
     Equipment Impairment Loss.  In connection with the replacement of
substantial portions of the European Network during 1995, the Company entered
into a termination agreement with Telemedia International Inc. ("TMI"). Pursuant
to the terms of such agreement, the Company prepaid the remaining lease
obligation of approximately $1.0 million, thereby acquiring all of the equipment
previously leased from TMI, most of which equipment was subsequently redeployed.
The Company recorded a non-cash charge of approximately $.6 million in 1995,
which represented the original installation costs of such equipment and the
difference between the carrying value and the expected selling price of the
equipment not expected to be redeployed.
 
     Interest.  Interest expense for 1995 increased by approximately $8.1
million from 1994 due to the accretion of non-cash interest on the Notes. This
expense was partially offset by interest income of approximately $3.3 million
for 1995 derived from the investment of the net proceeds from such issuance in
highly liquid debt instruments.
 
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
 
     Telecommunications Revenue.  Telecommunications revenue increased by
approximately 22.8% to $26.3 million on 15.1 million billable minutes in 1994
from $21.4 million on 10.9 million billable minutes in 1993. This growth in
telecommunications revenue resulted primarily from the Company's existing
markets. Part of this increase was offset by declining revenue per billable
minute rates. Average revenue
 
                                       26
<PAGE>   30
 
per billable minute declined by approximately 9.1% from $1.87 in 1993 to $1.70
in 1994. The decrease was due primarily to a change in the revenue mix, which in
1994 included a higher percentage of lower priced intra-European traffic, and a
reduction in rates in response to price reductions by certain ITOs. The number
of customers billed rose approximately 17.9% to 6,469 at December 31, 1994 from
5,486 at December 31, 1993.
 
     Cost of Telecommunications Services.  Cost of telecommunications services
increased to $23.0 million in 1994 from $18.2 million in 1993 and, as a
percentage of revenue, increased to approximately 87.4% in 1994 from
approximately 84.9% in 1993. The Company had priced its services to be
competitive with the ITOs in Spain and Italy in anticipation of the European
Network becoming operational; however, due to delays in the implementation of
the European Network, the Company realized significant losses on this traffic as
a result of having to route calls through ITF access instead of through the
European Network. In October 1994, the European Network became operational and
was used to originate approximately 48.0% of the Company's European call revenue
through the remainder of the year. This negative impact on gross margin was
partially offset by an approximately 8.4% decrease in average cost per billable
minute to $1.53 in 1994 from $1.67 in 1993. This decrease was attributable to
the migration in access from higher cost per minute ITF access to callback
access in Brazil and Argentina, traffic being routed through the European
Network and a general decline in U.S. switched international rates for outbound
services attributable to the Company's successful negotiation of favorable
rates.
 
     Selling Expenses.  Selling expenses increased to $4.5 million in 1994 from
$2.4 million in 1993 and, as a percentage of revenue, increased to approximately
17.0% in 1994 from approximately 11.2% in 1993. These expenses consisted
primarily of commissions paid to independent sales representatives in the
countries in which the Company did not operate its own direct sales
organizations. Commissions paid to these representatives ranged from five
percent to fifteen percent of revenue, net of chargebacks for amounts deemed
uncollectible in the period the related services were provided.
 
     General and Administrative Expense.  General and administrative expense
increased to $9.9 million in 1994 from $6.1 million in 1993 and, as a percentage
of revenue, increased to approximately 37.5% in 1994 and approximately 28.4% in
1993. A significant portion of the increase was attributable to building an
administrative infrastructure in the Company's New York, Omaha and European
offices and to hiring an experienced management team. In addition, during 1994
the Company charged to operations current costs associated with the European
Network which had been capitalized prior to the European Network becoming
operational.
 
     Depreciation and Amortization.  Depreciation and amortization expense,
which includes depreciation of the Viatel Network increased to $.8 million in
1994 from approximately $.1 million in 1993. The increase in such expense was
due primarily to the recognition of a full year of depreciation and amortization
expense with respect to the Omaha switching center, which was purchased on
October 1, 1993. In February 1994, the Company began to depreciate the European
Network, resulting in depreciation expense of approximately $.3 million in 1994.
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
     The Company has incurred losses from operating activities in each year of
operations since its inception and expects to continue to incur operating losses
for the next several years. Through March 31, 1996, the Company had incurred
$56.7 million of aggregate losses from operating activities. As of March 31,
1996, the Company had $23.1 million of cash, cash equivalents and other liquid
investments. The Company believes that, based on its current forecasts and
assuming the successful completion of the Offerings, the Company should be able
to fund its capital requirements at least until the year 1999 even though cash
flow from operations will continue to be negative until at least the year 2001.
 
     Capital Expenditures and Working Capital.  The development of the Company's
business has, in the past, required substantial capital expenditures. In the
future, the Company will require substantial capital expenditures significantly
in excess of historical levels to upgrade and expand the Viatel Network
generally, and the European Network specifically, as well as to develop and
expand new and existing services. Historically, the Company has funded its
capital expenditures through equity and debt issuances and vendor financings.
The Company expects to use the net proceeds of the Offerings to meet its capital
 
                                       27
<PAGE>   31
 
requirements, which include upgrade and expansion of the European Network in up
to 39 additional Western European cities by the year 2000. The Company estimates
that it will use approximately (i) $32.2 million of the net proceeds of the
Offerings for network upgrade and expansion, including the purchase and
installation of POPs or switches to expand the European Network from nine to up
to 48 Western European cities, the installation of a POP in Miami and a switch
in Los Angeles and for the upgrade of the Company's switch in London and its New
York City POP to a switch, (ii) $9.0 million for investments in digital undersea
fiber optic cable, (iii) $20.0 million for acquisitions of customer bases and
businesses or for investment in joint ventures or strategic alliances, and (iv)
$46.8 million for general corporate and working capital purposes, including up
to approximately $1.0 million for feasibility studies of the Company's provision
of CLEC services. See "Risk Factors -- Substantial Capital Requirements," "Risk
Factors -- Broad Discretion Over Use of Proceeds" and "Use of Proceeds."
 
     Average Monthly Cash Requirements.  During the three months ended March 31,
1996, the Company's average current monthly cash requirements were approximately
$2.0 million. This average excludes approximately (i) $3.2 million for capital
expenditures for the purchase of equipment, software and the continued
development of the European Network, (ii) $2.2 million incurred in connection
with the settlement of the Company's fee dispute for past services with a
facilities-based IPLC vendor to which the Company paid an additional $1.4
million for past services during the second quarter of 1996, and (iii) $.6
million for other non-recurring items.
 
     Interest Requirements and Debt Repayment.  Until January 15, 2000, the
Notes will accrue interest on a semi-annual basis to their aggregate $120.7
million principal amount. No interest is payable on the Notes until July 15,
2000, at which time semi-annual interest payments will be required through the
January 15, 2005 maturity date. If the Company is unable to generate sufficient
cash flow from operations to satisfy the debt service requirements on the Notes,
the Company will be required to refinance the Notes or raise additional capital.
There can be no assurance that any refinancing could be obtained on terms
favorable to the Company, if at all, or that any form of additional capital will
be available. In addition, the Indenture contains certain restrictive covenants
that, among other things, limit the ability of the Company and certain of its
subsidiaries to incur indebtedness, make pre-payments of certain indebtedness
and pay dividends. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
comply with such restrictive covenants in the future.
 
     Foreign Currency.  The Company has exposure to fluctuations in foreign
currencies relative to the U.S. dollar as a result of billing portions of its
revenue in the local currency in countries where the local currency is
relatively stable, while many of its obligations, including the Notes and a
substantial portion of its transmission costs, are denominated in U.S. dollars.
In countries with less stable currencies, such as Brazil, the Company bills in
U.S. dollars. For the three months ended March 31, 1996, approximately 53.0% of
the Company's revenue was billed in currencies other than the U.S. dollar.
Furthermore, substantially all of the costs of acquisition and upgrade of the
Company's switches have been, and will continue to be, U.S. dollar denominated
transactions.
 
     With the continued expansion of the European Network, a substantial portion
of the costs associated with the European Network, such as local access charges
and a portion of leased line costs, as well as a majority of local selling
expenses, will be charged to the Company in the same currencies as revenue is
billed. These developments create a natural hedge against a portion of the
Company's foreign exchange exposure. To date, much of the funding necessary to
establish the local direct sales organizations has been derived from revenue
that was billed in local currencies. Consequently, the Company's financial
position as of March 31, 1996 and its results of operations for the three months
ended March 31, 1996 were not significantly impacted by fluctuations in the U.S.
dollar in relationship to foreign currencies. See "Risk Factors -- Risks
Associated with International Operations."
 
INFLATION
 
     The Company does not believe that inflation has had a significant effect on
the Company's operations to date.
 
                                       28
<PAGE>   32
 
                                    BUSINESS
 
OVERVIEW
 
     Viatel is a growing provider of international and national long distance
telecommunications services principally in Western Europe, Latin America, the
United States and the Pacific Rim and offers its services primarily to small and
medium-sized businesses, carriers and other resellers. The Company operates a
digital, switch-based telecommunications network in Western Europe including a
central switching center in London and additional switches in Amsterdam,
Barcelona, Brussels, Frankfurt, Madrid, Milan, Paris and Rome connected by
leased, digital fiber optic transmission facilities. In addition, the Company
operates a switching center in Omaha, Nebraska which is connected to the central
switching center in London by leased, digital fiber optic transmission
facilities. The Company has achieved rapid growth since its inception in 1991
with telecommunications revenue reaching $32.3 million in 1995 and $10.6 million
during the three months ended March 31, 1996.
 
     The Company derives revenue primarily through the provision of
competitively priced long distance services with value-added features that are
not typically provided by the respective ITO in many of the countries in which
the Company operates. The Company's services include virtual private networks,
dedicated access for high volume users, calling cards, fax service and the
provision of switched minutes to wholesale customers. The value-added features
include itemized and multicurrency billing, abbreviated dialing and multiple
payment methods. Access to the Company's services is obtained through callback,
paid access, ITF, NTF or direct access through a dedicated line.
 
     The Company conducts its business on a global basis, with its principal
focus on Western Europe. Of the Company's telecommunications revenue for the
three months ended March 31, 1996, approximately 42.5% was generated in Western
Europe, approximately 29.6% was generated in Latin America, approximately 12.8%
was generated in North America, primarily from the Company's wholesale business
of selling switched minutes to other carriers and approximately 11.6% was
generated in the Pacific Rim. The remaining 3.5% was generated in Africa and the
Middle East.
 
BUSINESS STRATEGY
 
     The Company's objective is to be a significant provider of international
and national long distance telecommunications services within Western Europe and
other deregulating markets. The Company believes it is strategically positioned
to take advantage of fundamental changes occurring in the telecommunications
industry as a result of global deregulation and rapid advances in technology. In
particular, the Company believes that its early entry into the Western European
market as an alternative network operator has positioned it to take advantage of
the anticipated implementation of the EU's directives to eliminate the ITOs'
existing monopolies on Voice Telephony (as defined herein), scheduled to occur
by 1998 in most EU member states. The Company is currently prohibited from
supplying Voice Telephony in most EU member states until 1998. Accordingly, the
Company instead provides competitively priced international and national long
distance services with value-added features, thus positioning itself to
capitalize on anticipated deregulation. See "Risk Factors -- Substantial
Government Regulation" and "-- Government Regulation." Key elements of the
Company's business strategy include:
 
     -  FOCUS ON THE EUROPEAN MARKET; LEVERAGE EUROPEAN NETWORK.  To capitalize
        on opportunities presented by the changing regulatory environment and
        the size of the Western European market, the Company intends to further
        utilize and expand the European Network. During the three months ended
        March 31, 1996, approximately 42.5% of the Company's telecommunications
        revenue was generated in Western Europe, with approximately 33.5% of its
        revenue attributable to calls originated on the European Network. The
        Company intends to expand the European Network by installing POPs in
        cities with both significant calling activity directed to the Company's
        switch-based cities and significant potential for originating and
        terminating international and national long distance traffic. The
        Company anticipates installing POPs in up to 19 Western European cities
        in 1997, including Berlin, Lyon, Rotterdam, Turin, Valencia, Vienna and
        Zurich. The Company also intends to install a POP in Miami and a switch
        in Antwerp in the fourth
 
                                       29
<PAGE>   33
 
quarter of 1996. In the first quarter of 1997, the Company plans to upgrade its
switch in London, upgrade the New York City POP to a switch and install a switch
in Los Angeles. See "Risk Factors -- Substantial Government Regulation," "Risk
       Factors -- Potential Difficulties Associated With Implementing European
       Expansion Strategy," "Risk Factors -- Substantial Capital Requirements,"
       "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated With International Operations" and
       "-- Maintain Low-Cost Operations."
 
     -  CAPITALIZE ON ANTICIPATED SETTLEMENT AGREEMENT OBSOLESCENCE.  In
        contrast to many other companies engaged in the sale of international
        long distance services, the Company is not dependent on settlement
        agreements with ITOs for traffic origination and termination. The
        Company believes that the trend toward deregulation could hasten the
        anticipated obsolescence of settlement agreements, thus encouraging
        carriers to consider alternatives to the ITOs for long distance traffic
        termination. Currently, the European Network is primarily used to
        originate international long distance traffic from and within Western
        Europe. The Company plans to further leverage the European Network to
        take advantage of anticipated settlement agreement obsolescence by
        offering other carriers an alternative to the ITOs for long distance
        traffic origination and termination within Western Europe. While the
        anticipated trend toward settlement agreement obsolescence is likely to
        reduce prices for long distance services, the Company believes that
        increased utilization of the European Network for both origination and
        termination of traffic and reduced transmission costs should offset any
        such price reductions.
 
     -  MAINTAIN LOW-COST OPERATIONS.  The Company believes that the Viatel
        Network efficiently utilizes least cost routing ("LCR") of
        telecommunications traffic over multiple transmission facilities to: (i)
        reduce costs; (ii) control access to customer information; and (iii)
        allow increases in network usage without proportionate increases in
        costs. In addition, the Company pursues a disciplined, incremental
        approach to expansion. When the Company initially expands into a region
        it provides services on a variable cost basis. As traffic volume grows,
        the Company typically reconfigures the network by acquiring fixed-cost
        facilities with greater capacity thereby expanding the Company's
        addressable market on a cost-effective basis. See "-- The Viatel
        Network -- Expansion Plans."
 
     -  FOCUS ON SMALL AND MEDIUM-SIZED BUSINESSES.  The Company's principal
        target market consists of small and medium-sized businesses for which
        the cost of long distance telecommunications services represents a
        significant business expense. The Company believes that these customers
        tend to principally be focused on price and customer service. The
        Company also believes that, within any particular EU member state, the
        Company's services and pricing will be more attractive to such customers
        when, in addition to providing international long distance services, the
        Company provides national long distance services within such state. The
        Company believes that its ability to offer national and international
        long distance services to its targeted customers, and to bundle such
        services where desirable, will result in increased traffic volume on the
        European Network due to (i) existing high demand for national long
        distance service by the Company's targeted customers, (ii) potential
        savings which the customer would receive by purchasing both services
        from the Company and (iii) convenience associated with purchasing such
        services from a single vendor. See "-- Sales and Marketing; Customers."
 
     -  EXPAND WHOLESALE SWITCHED SERVICE.  To increase utilization of the
        Viatel Network, the Company sells switched minutes to wholesale
        customers and other resellers in the United States and the United
        Kingdom. Sales to such customers accounted for approximately 12.6% of
        the Company's telecommunications revenue for the three months ended
        March 31, 1996 (as compared to approximately 1.3% for the comparable
        period in 1995). The Company intends to continue to expand its wholesale
        service, thus providing the Company with a source of additional revenue
        and minutes originating and terminating on the Viatel Network.
 
     -  CONTINUE DEVELOPMENT OF LOCAL SALES DISTRIBUTION CHANNELS.  The
        Company's sales and marketing strategy is to leverage its locally based
        sales forces, which include direct and indirect
 
                                       30
<PAGE>   34
 
        sales representatives and telemarketing agents, to establish direct
        sales forces in other key Western European cities and augment the
        efforts of its direct local sales, marketing and customer service
        functions by utilizing non-exclusive independent representatives. The
        Company believes that the knowledge of its sales, marketing and customer
        service personnel of local systems, customs and languages increases the
        Company's ability to develop and serve its principal target customer
        base.
 
     -  LEVERAGE INFORMATION SYSTEMS.  The Company believes that integrated and
        reliable billing and information systems are key elements for growth and
        success in the telecommunications industry. Accordingly, the Company has
        made significant investments to acquire and implement sophisticated
        information systems which enable the Company to: (i) monitor and respond
        to customer needs by developing new and customized services; (ii) manage
        LCR; (iii) provide customized billing information; (iv) provide high
        quality customer service; (v) detect and minimize fraud; (vi) verify
        payables to suppliers; and (vii) rapidly integrate new customers. The
        Company believes that its network intelligence, billing and financial
        reporting systems enhance its ability to competitively meet the
        increasingly complex and demanding requirements of the international and
        national long distance markets. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
        Effective Information Systems" and "-- Information Systems."
 
     -  PURSUE ACQUISITIONS, INVESTMENTS AND STRATEGIC ALLIANCES.  The Company
        expects to pursue selective acquisitions of customer bases or
        businesses, make investments in companies that complement the Company's
        current operations or expand its services or network capabilities, and
        engage in strategic alliances. The Company believes that such
        acquisitions, investments and strategic alliances are an important means
        of increasing network traffic volume and achieving economies of scale.
        In particular, the Company believes that, in certain instances, it is
        more efficient to acquire customer bases than to develop such customer
        bases. See "Risk Factors -- Risks Associated With Acquisitions,
        Investments and Strategic Alliances."
 
MARKET OPPORTUNITY
 
     According to the ITU, the international telephone service industry had
total worldwide revenue of approximately $50.6 billion in 1994. While revenue
data is not available on a per country basis for Europe, Europe accounted for
approximately 45.0% or 24.0 billion of worldwide international outgoing voice
and voice band data minutes of use. The Company believes that, during 1996, the
Western European countries in which the Company currently operates or intends to
operate will represent approximately 22.6% or 13.6 billion of worldwide
international outgoing voice and voice band data revenue and approximately 35.2%
or 22.3 billion of related minutes of use.
 
     The Company also believes that, during 1996, the market for national long
distance voice and voice band data revenue in the Western European countries in
which the Company operates will represent approximately $41.7 billion or 196.9
billion minutes of use.
 
     In the Company's target markets, deregulation and new technologies have
resulted in increased competition between telecommunications service providers
and increased demand for the transmission of information across country borders.
Such deregulation and technological innovation has (i) decreased the cost of
providing toll service; (ii) enabled the provision of sophisticated value-added
features; and (iii) allowed other companies to compete with the ITOs.
 
     Historically, the respective ITO in each country has had the exclusive
right to provide telephone services within that country and, as a result, long
distance callers have paid relatively high prices for limited service. Since
1990, the EU telecommunications market has become increasingly liberalized, but
the provision of Voice Telephony is reserved to the local ITO in most EU member
states until scheduled deregulation in 1998. See "-- Government Regulation." In
response to the liberalization of telecommunications services within the EU, a
number of different competitors have emerged to compete with the ITOs, including
the Company, alliances between large United States telecommunications service
providers and ITOs and other competitors that primarily provide long distance
service through callback
 
                                       31
<PAGE>   35
 
access or through developing networks servicing specific geographic markets. See
"Risk Factors -- Competition" and "-- Competition."
 
     In the telecommunications industry, deregulation has coincided with
technological advances, which include utilization of fiber optic cable and
improved computer software and processing technology. Fiber optic cable, which
has widely replaced traditional copper wire lines for long distance
transmission, has dramatically increased the capacity, speed and flexibility of
transmission lines and has virtually eliminated limited capacity as a technical
barrier to entry for new international telephone companies. Improvements in
computer software and processing technology have allowed the provision of
value-added features such as itemized and multicurrency billing, international
debit and charge networks and ITF numbers.
 
     The Company believes, along with many industry observers, that the current
deregulation in many EU member states, coupled with technological innovation,
will lead to market developments similar to those that occurred upon
deregulation of long distance telecommunications services in the United States
and the United Kingdom, including an increase in traffic volume and the
continued introduction of multiple new providers of telecommunications services
of varying sizes. While significant reductions in prices and improvements in
telecommunications and customer services have occurred and are expected to
continue, the Company expects that market prices will continue to permit
services to be profitably rendered. See "Risk Factors -- Substantial Government
Regulation," "-- Government Regulation" and "-- Competition."
 
     The Company further believes that its operating experience in deregulating
markets in the United States and the United Kingdom, and its experience as an
early entrant in Western Europe, will assist it in identifying opportunities in
other deregulating countries with high density telecommunications traffic. The
Company also believes that its position in the Western European
telecommunications market and its experience providing international
telecommunications services will assist it in establishing a presence in
national long distance markets in Western Europe. The Company recently launched
national long distance telecommunications services in Spain and Italy and, based
upon favorable results in such markets, has determined to enter the national
long distance business in all EU member states in which it currently operates.
 
SERVICES
 
     The Company provides competitively priced long distance services with
value-added features that are not typically provided by the respective ITO in
many of the countries in which the Company operates. The Company's services
include virtual private networks, dedicated access for high volume users,
calling cards, fax service and the provision of switched minutes to wholesale
customers. The value-added features include itemized and multicurrency billing,
abbreviated dialing and multiple payment methods. See "-- The Viatel Network."
 
     Access to the Company's services is obtained either through "dial up
access" or "direct access." Dial up access requires the use of: (i) paid access,
which requires the customer to pay the ITO for the cost of accessing the
Company's services; (ii) callback, which enables the customer to receive a
return call providing a dial tone originated from the Company's Omaha, Nebraska
switching center; (iii) ITF, which accesses the Omaha, Nebraska switching center
by direct dial; or (iv) NTF, which accesses a local switch in the European
Network. Customers using direct access are connected to a Company switch by a
dedicated leased line.
 
     Paid access currently accounts for approximately 75.2% of the Company's
Western European revenue. To reduce the Company's costs and improve usage, the
Company has evolved from callback and ITF access to access by NTF numbers, paid
access and, ultimately, in the case of ViaCALL Plus, by direct access. Until
regulatory considerations permit, all customers outside of Europe, except for
wholesale customers, are expected to continue to access the Company's services
through callback or ITF numbers.
 
                                       32
<PAGE>   36
 
     The Company's principal services include:
 
     VIACALL -- enables virtual private network calling to a pre-defined group
of locations within a closed user group that can be modified as required,
subject only to regulatory limitations.
 
     VIACALL PLUS -- provides dedicated access via a leased line from the
customer to the Viatel Network, permitting calling without dialing access or
location codes.
 
     VIACALL EXPRESS -- provides a paid (local) access or toll free number
programmed to dial an existing phone number or system, generally in another
country, without the need for special circuits or modifications.
 
     VIAWORLDFAX -- permits calling for facsimile and other voice band data
services and is marketed exclusively in Western Europe. In the third quarter of
1996, the Company intends to simplify access to this service through the use of
automatic number identification, where feasible.
 
     VIACONNECT -- provides "anywhere to anywhere" international callback access
through manual, automatic, X.25 or Internet initiated callback. These services
are also offered with ITF access, subject to pricing considerations.
 
     VIAGLOBE -- provides calling card access from over 45 countries. In
addition to offering savings over the calling cards of AT&T Corp., MCI
Communications Corporation and other providers of credit-based international
calling cards, ViaGLOBE provides 24-hour operator assistance and speed dialing.
 
     The Company expects to introduce a new service in the second half of 1996
called ViaCARD. ViaCARD is a prepaid international debit card which provides
many of the same features as ViaGLOBE in a prepaid environment. The numerous
benefits and opportunities afforded customers with a prepaid card include better
internal cost controls and the ability to offer small denomination cards as
promotional items. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
launch ViaCARD in 1996 or thereafter or that, if launched, such service will be
successful.
 
     The Company markets its services under a number of registered and common
law service marks and uses various registered logos including "Viatel," a
federally registered service mark in the United States.
 
     In certain of the Company's existing and target markets there are laws or
regulations that either prohibit or limit, or could be used to prohibit or
limit, certain of the transmission methods by which the Company's services are
provided and the provision of certain of the Company's services. See "Risk
Factors -- Substantial Government Regulation" and "-- Government Regulation."
 
THE VIATEL NETWORK
 
     The Viatel Network consists of a central switching center in London, a
switching center in Omaha, Nebraska and switches in Amsterdam, Barcelona,
Brussels, Frankfurt, Madrid, Milan, Paris and Rome each connected by leased,
digital fiber optic transmission facilities. The Company's ownership of switches
reduces its reliance on other carriers, enables routing of telecommunications
traffic over multiple leased transmission lines, aids in controlling costs and
permits the compilation of call record data and other customer information. The
availability and price of existing transmission capacity for long distance
transmissions in the Company's primary geographic markets makes leasing of
transmission lines attractive and is expected to enable the Company to grow
network usage without incurring significant capital and operating costs. The
Company intends to use a significant portion of the net proceeds of the
Offerings to upgrade and expand the Viatel Network. See "Use of Proceeds,"
"-- Business Strategy -- Maintain Low-Cost Operations," and " -- Expansion
Plans."
 
     To originate and terminate calls on the European Network, the Company's
switches must have access and egress into and from the PSTN through local
connectivity. Each of the Company's services, other than ViaCALL Plus, requires
use of the PSTN to connect with a Company switch, using either a NTF
 
                                       33
<PAGE>   37
 
number or paid access. For ViaCALL Plus, local connectivity is provided by
dedicated leased lines that connect a customer's premises directly to a Company
switch. In each country, local connectivity is currently provided under tariffed
services offered by the ITO. See "Risk Factors -- Potential Difficulties
Associated With Implementing European Expansion Strategy."
 
     THE EUROPEAN NETWORK.  The European Network currently consists of a central
switching center in London and switches in the eight Western Europe cities
mentioned above. These cities were chosen as switch locations due to the
substantial number of international calls originating from such cities. The
European Network has been primarily used to originate traffic in Western Europe.
The Company anticipates increasing use of the European Network to terminate
traffic in Western Europe, particularly if settlement agreements become
obsolete. See "Risk Factors -- Potential Difficulties Associated With
Implementing European Expansion Strategy" and "-- Business
Strategy -- Capitalize on Anticipated Settlement Agreement Obsolescence."
 
     INTERNATIONAL PRIVATE LINE CIRCUITS.  The Company's eight switches in
Western Europe are connected to the central switching center in London by IPLCs,
except for the Barcelona switch which is connected to the Madrid switch through
an in-country private line circuit ("PLC"). IPLCs are permanent point-to-point
connections for voice and voice band data transmissions and are a less expensive
alternative to PSTNs, which are typically controlled by the local ITOs. The
Company transmits call traffic to Omaha, Nebraska from London and to London from
Omaha, Nebraska by an IPLC. The IPLCs connecting the Company's switches to the
central switching center in London are leased, directly or indirectly, through
third parties from the ITOs in the countries in which such calls originate.
 
     To reduce transmission costs and to provide additional capacity between the
United States and London, the Company (i) is in the process of acquiring an
indefeasible right of use ("IRU") in the portion of a transatlantic digital
fiber optic cable originating in the United States for transmission of traffic
between the United States and Europe, (ii) anticipates filing an application in
the third quarter of 1996 which would permit the Company to acquire an IRU in
transatlantic digital fiber optic cable originating in the United Kingdom and
(iii) is considering acquiring an IRU in cross-channel digital fiber optic cable
originating in the United Kingdom.
 
     INTELLIGENT SWITCHES.  The Viatel Network utilizes "intelligent switches"
which incorporate proprietary software to achieve LCR, the process by which the
Company optimizes the routing of calls over the Viatel Network for over 230
countries and territories. LCR allows calls that are not routed over the Viatel
Network to be routed directly from the Company's switches through the PSTN to
their destinations at the lowest rates. These switches also enable the Company
to efficiently perform billing functions and account activation and to render
value-added services. See "-- Information Systems."
 
     The Viatel Network uses high capacity programmable switching platforms
designed to deploy network-based intelligent services quickly and cost
effectively. The switches are modular and scaleable and incorporate advanced
technologies such as ISDN, hierarchical call control and SNMP network management
software. These switches can also provide a bridge between older and emerging
standards. As the Viatel Network continues to evolve, the installed base of
switches can be upgraded easily to create a cost effective scaleable service
switching point in an SS7 (an industry standard signaling protocol) based
network.
 
     REDUNDANCY.  In general, the Company relies upon the PSTN to provide
redundancy in the event of technical difficulties with the Viatel Network.
However, the Company maintains two facilities in Omaha, Nebraska to provide some
degree of redundancy in its back office operations, billing and switching
systems. The Company believes that the strategy of using the PSTN for redundancy
is more cost-effective than building its own redundant capacity, although there
can be no assurance that this will be the case in the future. To the extent that
customer demand over the European Network exceeds the Company's transmission
capacity, the Company may elect or be required to route overflow traffic over
the PSTN, and the Company may experience reduced margins and/or losses on such
calls. The Company's strategy is to monitor its anticipated traffic volume on a
regular basis and to increase IPLC and PLC
 
                                       34
<PAGE>   38
 
capacity before the capacity limitations of such circuits are reached. See "Risk
Factors -- Potential Difficulties Associated With Implementing European
Expansion Strategy."
 
     ECONOMIC BENEFITS OF THE NETWORK.  The economic benefits to Viatel of
owning and operating its own network arise principally from reduced transmission
costs. Calls that are not routed through the network generate significant higher
variable costs because they are connected using relatively expensive ITF numbers
or callback. In contrast, because the Viatel Network has significant fixed costs
associated with its operations, consisting primarily of leased line rental
charges, local connectivity and facility/network management costs, calls routed
through the Viatel Network have lower variable costs than off-network traffic.
Although the current traffic volume through the European portion of the
Company's network is too low to achieve desired economies of scale, transmission
costs are expected to decline as a percentage of revenue as call traffic through
the European Network increases. This economic benefit, however, is primarily
limited to traffic which either originates or terminates in a city where the
Company has a switch or POP. If a switch or POP does not exist in an origination
or destination city, the Company transports the call over the PSTN, at higher
transmission costs and reduced margins. Accordingly, as the European Network is
expanded, the Company anticipates being able to serve a greater number of
customers on a more cost effective basis. In the future, the Company expects
that most of its European calling traffic will originate or terminate through
the European Network both for international and national long distance calls. In
addition, as traffic patterns warrant, the Company expects to further reduce
transmission costs by connecting switches directly to one another with private
lines, bypassing the Company's switching centers in London and Omaha.
 
     EXPANSION PLANS.  The Company intends to use a significant portion of the
net proceeds of the Offerings to expand and upgrade the Viatel Network. The
Company plans to install a POP in Miami and a switch in Antwerp in the fourth
quarter of 1996. In the first quarter of 1997, the Company plans to upgrade its
switch in London, upgrade the New York City POP to a switch and install a switch
in Los Angeles. Switches that have been replaced will be redeployed to upgrade
POPs in other strategic locations. To further extend the European Network, the
Company also anticipates installing POPs in 19 European cities in 1997,
including Berlin, Lyon, Rotterdam, Turin, Valencia, Vienna and Zurich. Expanding
the European Network to include such additional major European business centers
should ultimately reduce transmission costs and increase the addressable market
of the European Network. See "Risk Factors -- Potential Difficulties Associated
With Implementing European Expansion Strategy." In addition, to further reduce
transmission costs, the Company (i) is in the process of acquiring an IRU in the
portion of a transatlantic digital fiber optic cable originating in the United
States for transmission of traffic between the United States and Europe, (ii)
anticipates filing an application in the third quarter of 1996 which would
permit the Company to acquire an IRU in transatlantic digital fiber optic cable
originating in the United Kingdom and (iii) is considering acquiring an IRU in
cross-channel digital fiber optic cable originating in the United Kingdom.
 
INFORMATION SYSTEMS
 
     The Company believes that integrated and reliable billing and information
systems are key elements for growth and success in the telecommunications
industry. Accordingly, the Company has made significant investments to acquire
and implement sophisticated information systems which enable the Company to: (i)
monitor and respond to customer needs by developing new and customized services;
(ii) manage LCR; (iii) provide customized billing information; (iv) provide high
quality customer service; (v) detect and minimize fraud; (vi) verify payables to
suppliers; and (vii) rapidly integrate new customers. The Company believes that
its network intelligence, billing and financial reporting systems enhance its
ability to competitively meet the increasingly complex and demanding
requirements of the international and national long distance markets. While the
Company believes that such systems are currently sufficient for its operations,
such network intelligence, selling and financial reporting systems will require
enhancements and ongoing investments. See "Risk Factors -- Dependence on
Effective Information Systems" and "-- Business Strategy -- Leverage Information
Systems."
 
                                       35
<PAGE>   39
 
     The Company currently has a turnaround time of approximately 24 hours for
new account entry. The Company's billing system provides multicurrency billing,
itemized call detail, city level detail for destination reporting and electronic
output for select accounts. Customers are provided with several payment options,
including automated credit card processing and automated direct debiting.
 
     The Company has developed proprietary software to provide
telecommunications services and render customer support. In contrast to most
traditional telecommunications companies, the software used to support the
European Network resides outside of the switches and, therefore, does not
currently rely on third party switch manufacturers for upgrades. The Company
believes its software configuration facilitates the rapid development and
deployment of new services and provides the Company with a competitive
advantage. Each switch has a call detail recording function which enables the
Company to: (i) achieve accelerated collection of call records; (ii) detect
fraud and unauthorized usage; and (iii) permit rapid call detail record
analysis. See "-- The Viatel Network -- Intelligent Switches."
 
     The Company also uses its proprietary software to assist it in analyzing
traffic patterns and determining network usage and busy hour percentage,
originating traffic by switching center, terminating traffic by supplier and
originating traffic by customer. This data is utilized to optimize LCR, which
may result in call traffic being transmitted over the Company's transmission
facilities, other carriers' transmission facilities or a combination of such
facilities. If traffic cannot be handled over the least cost route due to
overflow, the LCR system is designed to transmit the traffic over the next least
cost route. The LCR system chooses among the following variables to minimize the
cost of a long distance call: (i) over 15 different suppliers; (ii) 24 different
time zones; and (iii) multiple choices of terminating carrier per country. The
performance of the LCR system is verified based on a daily overflow report
generated by the Company's network traffic management and a weekly/monthly
average termination cost report generated by the Company's billing system. See
"Risk Factors -- Dependence on Effective Information Systems."
 
SALES AND MARKETING; CUSTOMERS
 
     From 1991 to 1994, the Company's sales and marketing efforts were conducted
by independent sales representatives in each of its markets. In late 1994, the
Company began establishing its own direct sales forces in certain Western
European and Latin American countries to take greater control over the sales and
marketing functions and to provide a higher level of customer service.
Currently, the Company has direct sales forces in the nine cities in Western
Europe in which it has switches. The Company intends to establish direct sales
forces in other key Western European cities and to utilize non-exclusive
independent representatives to augment the efforts of its direct sales forces.
This strategy is expected to provide the Company with the benefits derived from
a direct sales organization while minimizing the organizational and other fixed
costs associated with such an undertaking.
 
     The initial phase of development of the Company's direct sales organization
in a given country involves setting up a team of salespeople led by a sales
manager and supported by a centralized telemarketing and customer service team.
Over time, the Company expects each country in which it provides services to be
served by multiple sales teams under the leadership of a country manager and a
central telemarketing team responsible for generating new sales leads. The
Company does not engage in general advertising, but instead uses local
advertising directed to its target customer base.
 
     The Company's principal target market consists of small and medium-sized
businesses. This market includes trading companies, financial institutions, call
centers and import-export companies, for which long distance telecommunications
service represents a significant business expense. The Company also targets
carriers and other resellers. The Company has four sales professionals dedicated
to marketing and maintaining the Company's relationships with its wholesale
customers in the United States and in the United Kingdom. Currently, no customer
of the Company individually accounts for more than 5% of the Company's revenues.
 
     In addition to providing long distance services to third party call
centers, the Company believes that it can profitably establish its own call
centers within certain Western European cities which will provide
 
                                       36
<PAGE>   40
 
the ViaCALL Plus service. Call centers are primarily used by students, travelers
and other expatriates as an alternative to coin telephone, callback or third
party billed calls. The Company believes that the establishment of its own call
centers will enable it to earn high margin revenue while controlling credit
problems associated with third party call centers.
 
     The Company employs a decentralized approach to pricing non-wholesale
services and, as a result, its discount relative to the ITOs' prices varies
among geographic markets. For its non-wholesale services, the Company offers
discounts to the prices charged by the ITO in each market, which discounts
typically range from approximately 10.0% to approximately 20.0% for
international calls and from approximately 20.0% to approximately 40.0% for
intercontinental calls. In those markets where the Company currently provides
national long distance services, the discounts typically range from
approximately 8.0% to approximately 28.0%.
 
     The Company generally sets its wholesale rates on a case by case basis with
an overall margin objective based upon a customer traffic profile. The rates
charged are generally priced at or below the market price of the leading United
States international facilities-based carriers, but the Company does not offer a
standard discount relative to any major carrier.
 
CARRIER CONTRACTS
 
     The Company has entered into contracts to purchase switched minute capacity
from various domestic and foreign carriers and depends on such contracts for
origination and termination of traffic on the Viatel Network as well as for
resale of such capacity to others. Carrier costs constitute a significant
portion of the Company's variable costs. Pursuant to these contracts, the
Company obtains guaranteed rates, which are generally more favorable than
otherwise would be available, by committing to purchase switched minute minimums
from such carriers. If the Company fails to meet its switched minute minimum
requirements under a carrier contract, it could still be required to pay its
minimum monthly commitment as a penalty. The Company's aggregate minimum monthly
commitments are $.53 million, which represents less than 20.0% of the Company's
monthly variable transmission expense. The Company has never paid a penalty for
failing to meet such a commitment. The Company does not believe that the loss of
any one supplier or contract would have a material adverse impact on the
Company's business, financial condition or results of operations. See
"-- Competition."
 
COMPETITION
 
     The international telecommunications industry is highly competitive. The
Company's success depends upon its ability to compete with a variety of other
telecommunications providers in each of its markets, including the respective
ITO in each country in which the Company operates and global alliances among
some of the world's largest telecommunications carriers. Other potential
competitors include cable television companies, wireless telephone companies,
electric and other utilities with rights of way, railways, microwave carriers
and large end users which have private networks. The intensity of such
competition has recently increased and the Company believes that such
competition will continue to intensify as the number of new entrants increases.
Many of the Company's current or potential competitors have substantially
greater financial, marketing and other resources than the Company. If the
Company's competitors devote significant additional resources to the provision
of international or national long distance telecommunications services to the
Company's target customer base of small and medium-sized businesses, such action
could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations, and there can be no assurance that the
Company will be able to compete successfully against such new or existing
competitors. See "Risk Factors -- Competition."
 
     Competition for customers in the telecommunications industry is primarily
based on price and, to a lesser extent, on the type and quality of services
offered. The Company prices its services primarily by offering discounts to the
prices charged by its competitors. The Company has no control over the prices
set by its competitors, and some of the Company's competitors may be able to use
their financial resources to cause severe price competition in the countries in
which the Company operates. Although
 
                                       37
<PAGE>   41
 
the Company does not believe that there is an economic incentive for its
competitors to pursue such a pricing strategy or that its competitors are likely
to engage in such a course of action, there can be no assurance that severe
price competition will not occur. Any such price competition would have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. Additionally, intensified competition in certain of the
Company's markets will cause the Company to continue to reduce its prices. For
example, the Company recently reduced certain rates which it charges to end
users in response to pricing reductions enacted by certain ITOs. Such price
reductions may reduce the Company's revenue and margins. The Company has
experienced, and expects to continue to experience, declining revenue per
billable minute in all of its markets in part as a result of increasing
worldwide competition within the telecommunications industry.
 
     In response to deregulation, additional competitors of various sizes are
beginning to emerge in Western Europe. The Company's services are currently
marketed to small and medium-sized businesses, however, and thus the Company
generally does not directly compete with mega-carrier alliances which generally
target larger customers. The Company's ViaCALL Plus service is targeted at
medium-sized businesses and may in the future compete with some services offered
by the mega-carrier alliances. In addition, many smaller carriers have emerged,
most of which specialize in offering intercontinental telephone services
utilizing dial up access methods, and some of which have begun to build networks
similar to the European Network. Although these competitors have focused
primarily on London, several have expressed an intention to build networks
across Europe in the future.
 
     The Company believes that the ITOs generally have certain competitive
advantages due to their control over local connectivity and apparent close ties
with national regulatory authorities. The Company also believes that, in certain
instances, some regulators have shown a reluctance to adopt policies and grant
regulatory approvals that would result in increased competition for the local
ITO. The Company believes that, at least in the short-term, the ITOs will not
concentrate on marketing their services to the Company's small and medium-sized
business customer base. As a result, the Company does not believe that the ITOs
will seek to apply pressure on national regulators to prevent it from providing
its services; however, there can be no assurance that the ITOs will not apply
such pressure in the future. If the ITOs were to successfully apply such
pressure on national regulators, the Company could be denied regulatory approval
in certain jurisdictions in which its services would otherwise be permitted,
thereby requiring the Company to seek judicial or other legal enforcement of its
right to provide services. Any delay in obtaining approval, or failure to obtain
approval, could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations.
 
     The Company believes that it has encountered anti-competitive behavior on
the part of certain ITOs. If the Company encounters anti-competitive behavior in
countries in which it operates or if the ITO in any country in which it operates
uses its competitive advantages to the fullest extent, the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations could be materially adversely
affected. See "Risk Factors --Competition."
 
GOVERNMENT REGULATION
 
     OVERVIEW.  The Company's provision of international and national long
distance telecommunications services is heavily regulated. Many of the countries
in which the Company provides, or intends to provide, services prohibit or limit
the services which the Company can provide and the transmission methods by which
it can provide such services. For example, in the United States, the Company's
authority to engage in the resale of international private line communications
services is pursuant to the Section 214 Private Line Authorization. Certain
rules of the FCC prohibit the Company from (i) transmitting calls routed over
the Company's leased line between the United States and the United Kingdom
onward over the European Network (other than to countries which the FCC deems to
be "equivalent," currently the United Kingdom, Canada and Sweden) or (ii)
transmitting calls from European countries (other than those deemed to be
equivalent) over the European Network and then onward over its leased line
between the United States and the United Kingdom. If a violation of FCC rules
concerning resale of international private line service were found to exist and
to be sufficiently
 
                                       38
<PAGE>   42
 
severe, the FCC could impose sanctions and penalties including revocation of the
Section 214 Private Line Authorization. FCC restrictions thus materially limit
the optimal and most profitable use of the Company's leased line between the
United States and the United Kingdom.
 
     In addition, the Company provides its customers located outside the EU,
and, to a lesser degree within the EU, with access to its services through the
use of callback. A substantial number of countries have prohibited certain forms
of callback as a mechanism to access the Company's services. This has caused the
Company to cease providing services in some jurisdictions, including Kuwait,
Costa Rica and Jordan, and may require it to do so in other countries in the
future. There can be no assurance that certain of the Company's services and
transmission methods will not continue to be or will not become prohibited in
certain jurisdictions, and, depending on the jurisdictions, services and
transmission methods affected, there could be a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "Risk
Factors -- Substantial Government Regulation."
 
     Local laws and regulations differ significantly among the jurisdictions in
which the Company operates, and, within such jurisdictions, the interpretation
and enforcement of such laws and regulations can be unpredictable. For example,
EU member states have inconsistently and, in some instances, unclearly
implemented the Services Directive under which the Company provides voice
services for CUGs in Western Europe. As a result, some EU member states may
limit, constrain or otherwise adversely affect the Company's ability to provide
certain services. There can be no assurance that certain EU member states will
implement, or will implement consistently, the Services Directive or the Full
Competition Directive adopted by the EU in March 1996, and either the failure to
implement or inconsistent implementation of such directives could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations.
 
     The Company has pursued and expects to continue to pursue a strategy of
providing its services to the maximum extent it believes permissible under
applicable laws and regulations. For example, the Company provides its ViaGLOBE
service to individuals for calling within the EU and such service may constitute
prohibited Voice Telephony. A further example of the Company's aggressive
interpretation of indefinite or unfavorable laws is its provision of services
utilizing the callback access method in Colombia, where the Colombian Ministry
of Communications has stated that callback access is not permitted and has so
notified the FCC, and in other Latin American countries, where services
utilizing such access method may not currently be permitted.
 
     The Company's aggressive strategy may result in the Company's (i) providing
services or using transmission methods that violate local laws or regulations or
(ii) failing to obtain formal approvals required under such laws or regulations.
Where the Company is found to be in violation of local laws and regulations, it
usually seeks to modify its operations so as to comply with such laws and
regulations. There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will not be
subject to fines, penalties or other sanctions as a result of past violations
even though such violations were corrected. In addition, if the Company believes
that it has a legal basis for doing so, it may persist in providing such
services, using such transmission methods, or otherwise continuing such actions.
If the Company's interpretation of applicable laws and regulations proves
incorrect, it could lose, or be unable to obtain, regulatory approvals,
including the Section 214 Private Line Authorization or the Section 214 Switched
Authorization, necessary to provide certain of its services or to use certain of
its transmission methods. The Company also could have substantial monetary fines
and penalties imposed against it. In addition, the Section 214 Private Line
Authorization requires that services be provided "in a manner consistent with
the laws and regulations of the countries in which [the Company] operates."
There can be no assurance that the Company has accurately interpreted or will
accurately interpret applicable laws and regulations in particular
jurisdictions.
 
     The Company may be incorrect in its assumption that (i) EU member states
will abolish on a timely basis the respective ITO's monopoly to provide Voice
Telephony within and between such member states, as required by the Services
Directive and the Full Competition Directive, (ii) deregulation will continue to
occur or (iii) it will be allowed to continue to provide and to expand its
services. The
 
                                       39
<PAGE>   43
 
Company's provision of services in Europe may also be affected if any EU member
state imposes greater restrictions on non-EU international service than on such
service within the EU. There can be no assurance that the United States or
foreign jurisdictions will not adopt laws or regulatory requirements that will
adversely affect the Company. Additionally, there can be no assurance that
future United States or foreign regulatory, judicial or legislative changes will
not have a material adverse effect on the Company or that regulators or third
parties will not raise material issues with regard to the Company's compliance
with applicable laws or regulations. If the Company is unable to provide the
services it is presently providing or intends to provide or to use its existing
or contemplated transmission methods due to its inability to receive or retain
formal or informal approvals for such services or transmission methods, or for
any other reason related to regulatory compliance or the lack thereof, such
events could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. See "Risk Factors -- Substantial Government
Regulation."
 
     REGULATORY FRAMEWORK.  A summary discussion of the regulatory frameworks in
certain geographic regions in which the Company operates or has targeted for
penetration is set forth below. This discussion is intended to provide a general
outline of the more relevant regulations and current regulatory posture of the
various jurisdictions and is not intended as a comprehensive discussion of such
regulations or regulatory posture.
 
     Europe.  In Europe, the regulation of the telecommunications industry is
governed at a supra-national level by the EU (consisting of the following member
states: Austria, Belgium, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Ireland,
Italy, Luxembourg, the Netherlands, Portugal, Spain, Sweden and the United
Kingdom) which is responsible for creating pan-European policies and, through
legislation, a regulatory framework to ensure an open, competitive
telecommunications market. The EU was established by the Treaty of Rome and
subsequent conventions and was authorized by such treaties to issue EU
"directives." EU member states are required to implement these directives
through national legislation. If an EU member state fails to adopt such
directives, the European Commission may take action, including referral to the
European Court of Justice, to enforce the directives.
 
     In 1990, the EU issued the Services Directive requiring each EU member
state to abolish existing monopolies in telecommunications services, with the
exception of Voice Telephony. The effect of the Services Directive was to permit
the competitive provision of all services other than Voice Telephony, including
value-added services and voice services within CUGs. However, as a consequence
of local implementation of the Services Directive through the adoption of
national legislation, there are differing interpretations as to the definition
of prohibited Voice Telephony and permitted value-added and CUG services. Voice
services which use leased lines for customer access, such as ViaCALL Plus, are
permissible in all EU member states. The European Commission has generally taken
a narrow view of the services classified as Voice Telephony declaring that voice
services may not be reserved to the ITOs if (i) dedicated customer access is
used to provide the service, (ii) the service confers new value-added benefits
on users (such as alternative billing methods) or (iii) calling is limited by a
service provider to a group having legal, economic or professional ties.
 
     Notwithstanding the Services Directive, Greece, Ireland, Portugal and
Spain, each of which has a less developed network, and Luxembourg, which has a
very small network, may, provided it is necessary to achieve a structural
adjustment, delay the abolition of the Voice Telephony monopoly until 2003 and
2000, respectively. Spain volunteered to implement the Services Directive by
1998, but certain Spanish officials have recently indicated that they may
reconsider this decision and postpone the abolition of the Voice Telephony
monopoly.
 
     In March 1996, the EU adopted the Full Competition Directive containing two
key provisions which required EU member states to allow the creation of
alternative telecommunications infrastructures by July 1, 1996, and which
reaffirmed the obligation of EU member states to abolish the ITOs' monopolies in
Voice Telephony by 1998. The Full Competition Directive encouraged EU member
states to accelerate liberalization of Voice Telephony. To date, Sweden,
Finland, Denmark and the United Kingdom have liberalized facilities-based
services to all routes. However, Greece, Ireland, Portugal, Spain and Luxem-
 
                                       40
<PAGE>   44
 
bourg may apply to the European Commission to delay for up to 5 years the
provisions of the Full Competition Directive relating to the liberalization of
Voice Telephony or alternative infrastructures. Certain Spanish officials have
indicated that Spain will apply for such derogation.
 
     Each EU member state in which the Company currently conducts its business
has a different regulatory regime and such differences are expected to continue
beyond January 1998. The requirements for the Company to obtain necessary
approvals vary considerably from country to country. The Company believes that,
to the extent required, it has either filed applications, received comfort
letters or obtained licenses from the applicable regulatory authorities.
 
     United States.  The Company's provision of international service to, from,
and through the United States is subject to regulation by the FCC. Section 214
of the Communications Act requires a company to make application to, and receive
authorization from, the FCC to, among other things, resell telecommunications
services of other U.S. carriers with regard to international calls. In May 1994,
the FCC authorized the Company pursuant to Section 214 of the Communications Act
(the "Section 214 Switched Authorization") to resell public switched
telecommunications services of other U.S. carriers. As previously noted, the FCC
has also granted the Section 214 Private Line Authorization. The Section 214
Private Line Authorization requires that services be provided in a manner that
is consistent with the laws of countries in which the Company operates. As
described above, the Company's aggressive regulatory strategy could result in
the Company's providing services that ultimately may be considered to be
provided in a manner that is inconsistent with local law. If the FCC finds that
the Company has violated the terms of the Section 214 Private Line
Authorization, it could impose a variety of sanctions on the Company, including
fines, additional conditions on the Section 214 Private Line Authorization,
cease and desist or show cause orders or the revocation of the Section 214
Private Line Authorization, the latter of which is usually imposed only in the
case of serious violations. The FCC has the authority to take the same action
with respect to the Section 214 Switched Authorization. Depending upon the
sanction imposed, such sanction could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. See "Risk
Factors -- Substantial Government Regulation".
 
     In order to conduct its business involving the origination and termination
of calls in the United States, the Company must use leased lines. In October
1995, YYC Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, obtained the Section
214 Private Line Authorization from the FCC to resell international private line
service between the United States and the United Kingdom, with the private line
interconnected to the PSTN, for the purpose of providing switched
telecommunications services. The Company plans to seek FCC approval of the pro
forma transfer of the Section 214 Private Line Authorization from YYC Inc. to
the Company itself. The FCC restricts the use of the leased line between the
United States and the United Kingdom to the handling of traffic that enters or
exits the United Kingdom end of the leased line via the PSTN. The FCC currently
prohibits the Company from using the leased line between the United States and
the United Kingdom to carry to the United States any calls that originate on the
European Network at switches outside of the United Kingdom. The FCC also
prohibits the Company from using the leased line between the United States and
the United Kingdom to carry United States-originated calls that will be handed
off to the European Network for delivery to countries on the European continent.
The FCC has imposed this prohibition because no continental EU member state
offers US telecommunications service providers competitive opportunities that
are "equivalent" to those available in the United States. To date, the FCC has
found that only Canada, the United Kingdom and Sweden offer such opportunities.
Following implementation of the Full Competition Directive by EU member states,
the FCC may authorize the Company to originate and terminate traffic over the
leased line between the United States and the United Kingdom and the European
Network to additional member states if the FCC finds that they provide
equivalent competitive opportunities. However, there can be no assurance that
the FCC will find such equivalence.
 
     Latin America.  The Company is subject to a different regulatory regime in
each country in Latin American in which it conducts business. Local regulations
determine issues significant to the Company's business, including whether it can
obtain authorization to offer transmission of voice and voice band data directly
or through callback. In general, competition is restricted in the region, with
the result that the
 
                                       41
<PAGE>   45
 
Company's ability to offer such service is limited. Regulations governing
enhanced services (such as facsimile and voicemail and data transmission) tend
to be more permissive than those covering Voice Telephony.
 
     Some countries in Latin America oppose the provision of callback. The Latin
American countries in which the Company conducts the greatest portion of its
business are Brazil, Colombia and Argentina. In Brazil, callback is currently
permissible but the Company has experienced opposition in the past and will
likely experience such opposition in the future. In Colombia, the Ministry of
Communications has stated that callback access is prohibited and has so notified
the FCC. The Company does not believe that the Ministry of Communications has
the requisite authority to regulate in this area, and this is the subject of
litigation brought by a third party in the Colombian courts. At present,
regulations appear to permit callback access in Argentina. However, the
regulatory agency in Argentina has changed its position regarding callback
access on several occasions in the past.
 
EMPLOYEES
 
     At June 30, 1996, the Company had 236 full-time employees, approximately
108 of whom were engaged in sales, marketing and customer service. None of the
Company's employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement. Management
believes that the Company's relationship with its employees is good.
 
PROPERTIES
 
     The Company currently occupies approximately 6,000 square feet of office
space in New York, New York, which serves as the Company's principal executive
office. The lease has an annual rental obligation of approximately $174,300 and
expires on January 31, 2001. The Company also leases an aggregate of
approximately 17,850 square feet of office space at two sites in Omaha,
Nebraska, which serve as the Company's operations center and its United States
switching center. The lease terms of the two sites have an annual combined
rental obligation of approximately $112,000 and expire on March 31, 1997 and
July 31, 2000, respectively. The Company has a renewal option for two years on
one of the sites, each year at a rent comparable to that paid during the initial
term of the lease.
 
     The Company also leases office space in various cities in Europe where it
maintains sales offices with annual rents ranging from $19,600 in Rome to
$192,000 in Frankfurt (based on foreign currency exchange rates in effect as of
June 30, 1996). The Company's aggregate annual rental obligations for its
European properties is approximately $740,000 (based on foreign currency
exchange rates in effect as of June 30, 1996).
 
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
     On June 5, 1996, a French arbitration tribunal rendered a judgment against
the Company in connection with a claim by an independent sales representative
(the "Claimant") for alleged breach of contract and certain other claims. The
Claimant requested total monetary damages of approximately $3 million and sought
reinstatement as the Company's exclusive sales representative in France.
Although the arbitration panel awarded the Claimant FF 4.3 million ($.86 million
based on foreign currency exchange rates in effect as of July 31, 1996), the
panel terminated the Claimant's sales agency. This award is subject to interest
accruing at an annual rate of 6.5% commencing January 1995.
 
     On January 23, 1996, the Company's independent sales representative in
Madrid (the "Spanish Representative") commenced an arbitration proceeding before
the American Arbitration Association claiming a breach by the Company of a
contract between the Spanish Representative and the Company relating to the
improper termination of such agreement by the Company. The Spanish
Representative is seeking $5.8 million in damages. On February 8, 1996, the
Company obtained, in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, County of
Nassau, an order to show cause bringing an application to stay the arbitration
on the ground that the Company did not agree to arbitrate breach of contract
disputes. The Court issued a temporary restraining order that stayed the
arbitration proceeding pending determination of the motion. On February 29,
1996, the attorneys for the Spanish Representative removed the action pending in
the Supreme Court of the State of New York to the United States District Court
for the Eastern
 
                                       42
<PAGE>   46
 
District of New York and cross-moved for an order compelling arbitration. The
Company believes that the dispute is not subject to arbitration and, in any
event, that it has meritorious defenses against each of the claims alleged by
the Spanish Representative. The Company intends to vigorously pursue all
defenses available to it.
 
     The Company is also involved from time to time in other litigation
incidental to the conduct of its business. The Company believes that the
judgment rendered against it by the French arbitration panel and any potential
adverse determination of the Spanish Representative or an adverse decision in
any other pending action will not have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
                                       43
<PAGE>   47
 
                                   MANAGEMENT
 
DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS
 
     The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the
directors and executive officers of the Company.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
              NAME                 AGE                         POSITION
- ---------------------------------  ----  -----------------------------------------------------
<S>                                <C>   <C>
Martin Varsavsky.................    36  President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
Michael J. Mahoney(1)............    37  Executive Vice President, Operations and Technology;
                                           Managing Director, Intercontinental and Director
Allan L. Shaw(2).................    32  Vice President, Finance; Chief Financial Officer and
                                           Director
Mark St. J. Courtney.............    37  European General Counsel and Secretary
Sheldon M. Goldman...............    36  United States General Counsel and Assistant Secretary
Paolo Di Fraia...................    35  European Finance Director
W. James Peet(1)(2)..............    41  Director
Paul G. Pizzani(1)(2)............    36  Director
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Member of the Company's Compensation Committee
 
(2) Member of the Company's Audit Committee
 
     Martin Varsavsky.  Mr. Varsavsky, a founder of the Company, has served as
its President and Chief Executive Officer and as a director since February 1991.
Mr. Varsavsky also founded both Urban Capital Corporation, a commercial real
estate development company, and Medicorp Sciences, a biotechnology company which
conducts AIDS research, in 1985. Mr. Varsavsky is related by marriage to Mr.
Juan Manuel Aisemberg, a principal stockholder of the Company.
 
     Michael J. Mahoney.  Mr. Mahoney has served as the Company's Executive Vice
President, Operations and Technology since July 1994 and Managing Director,
Intercontinental since January 1996. Mr. Mahoney has served as a director of the
Company since 1995. From August 1990 to June 1994, Mr. Mahoney was employed by
SITEL Corporation, a telemarketing services company, most recently as President,
Information Services Group. From August 1987 to August 1990, Mr. Mahoney was
employed by URIX Corporation, a manufacturer of telecommunications hardware and
software, in a variety of sales and marketing positions, most recently as the
Director, Product Marketing.
 
     Allan L. Shaw.  Mr. Shaw has served as the Company's Vice President,
Finance and Chief Financial Officer since January 1996. Mr. Shaw has served as a
director of the Company since June 1996. Prior to becoming the Company's Vice
President, Finance and Chief Financial Officer, Mr. Shaw served as Corporate
Controller of the Company from November 1994 to December 1995. From August 1987
to November 1994, Mr. Shaw was employed by Deloitte & Touche LLP, most recently
as a Manager. Mr. Shaw is a Certified Public Accountant and a member of the
American Institute, United Kingdom Society and New York State Society of
Certified Public Accountants.
 
     Mark St. J. Courtney.  Mr. Courtney has served as the Company's European
General Counsel since August 1995 and as Secretary of the Company since March
1996. From December 1992 to July 1995, Mr. Courtney served as European and
International Counsel for Legent, Inc., a software company, and from April 1991
to November 1992, Mr. Courtney served as Legal Counsel for ICL, Ltd., a U.K.
hardware and computer services company. Mr. Courtney was employed by Lloyds
Merchant Bank, a U.K. investment bank, from November 1985 to March 1991.
 
     Sheldon M. Goldman.  Mr. Goldman has served as the Company's United States
General Counsel since April 1996. From January 1987 to March 1996, Mr. Goldman
was associated with the law firm of
 
                                       44
<PAGE>   48
 
Wien, Malkin & Bettex. Since March 1996, Mr. Goldman has been Of Counsel to the
law firm of Brief Kesselman Knapp & Schulman, LLP.
 
     Paolo Di Fraia.  Mr. Di Fraia has served as the Company's European Finance
Director since January 1996. From November 1994 to December 1995, Mr. Di Fraia
served as European Controller of the Company. From April 1989 to August 1994,
Mr. Di Fraia was employed by Philip Crosby Associates, S.A. as European
Controller.
 
     W. James Peet.  Mr. Peet has served as a director of the Company since
November 1995. He is Vice President of The Chatterjee Group, an affiliate of S-C
V-Tel, a principal stockholder of the Company, and has been associated with The
Chatterjee Group since August 1991. From June 1985 to July 1991, Mr. Peet was a
management consultant employed by McKinsey & Company.
 
     Paul G. Pizzani.  Mr. Pizzani has served as a director of the Company since
April 1996. He is the Vice President of Finance and Business Planning of COMSAT
International Ventures, a division of COMSAT Corporation, where he has been
employed in various capacities since November 1985. COMSAT Investments, Inc., an
affiliate of COMSAT Corporation, is a principal stockholder of the Company.
 
SENIOR MANAGEMENT
 
     Patrick Attallah.  Mr. Attallah has served as the Company's Regional
Director for Southern Europe since April 1996. From August 1995 to March 1996,
Mr. Attallah served as the Company's Country Manager of France. Prior to joining
the Company, Mr. Attallah was employed at Telemedia International, Ltd. from
October 1994 to July 1995 as a senior account manager and was employed by Sprint
International in various capacities from September 1989 to September 1994, most
recently as the Indirect Sales Director in France.
 
     Alfredo Candal.  Mr. Candal has served as the Company's Regional Manager
for Latin America since January 1996 and as the Company's Latin American
Business Development Manager from May 1995 to December 1995. Prior to such date,
Mr. Candal served as the Company's Acting Country Manager for Italy from
December 1994 to May 1995 and as Latin American specialist from October 1993 to
December 1994.
 
     Alfred Heilbron.  Mr. Heilbron became a consultant to the Company in May
1995 and, in this capacity, acts as the Company's Regional Director for Northern
Europe. From October 1993 to April 1995, Mr. Heilbron acted as the Company's
agent in Belgium through his wholly owned corporation, Across International
Limited. For at least three years prior to becoming affiliated with the Company,
Mr. Heilbron was self employed.
 
     Fred Hughes.  Mr. Hughes has served as the Company's Vice President,
Operations since July 1994. From August 1993 to July 1994, Mr. Hughes served as
the Company's Director of Telephony. From January 1991 to August 1993, Mr.
Hughes was President of Communications Services Group, a Connecticut-based voice
and data communications consulting company. From August 1988 to January 1991,
Mr. Hughes was Director of Engineering at Millicom Telecommunications Services,
Inc.
 
     Larry Malone.  Mr. Malone has served as the Company's Vice President of
Carrier/Wholesale Sales since January 1995. From December 1987 to December 1994,
Mr. Malone was employed by Republic Telcom Systems, a voice/data networking
company, where he most recently served as Director of Sales.
 
     George Pieraccini.  Mr. Pieraccini has served as the Company's Corporate
Controller since January 1996. Mr. Pieraccini served as the Company's Assistant
Controller from November 1994 until December 1995. From October 1991 to November
1994, Mr. Pieraccini was employed as an Audit Senior at Edward Isaacs & Company
LLP, independent Certified Public Accountants. Mr. Pieraccini is a Certified
Public Accountant and a member of the American Institute and the New York State
Society of Certified Public Accountants.
 
                                       45
<PAGE>   49
 
     Phil Wilken.  Mr. Wilken has served as the Company's Vice President of
Operations since joining the Company in March 1996. From October 1995 to
February 1996, Mr. Wilken was a private consultant in the telecommunications
industry. Mr. Wilken was employed by CNA Insurance in various capacities from
January 1983 to September 1995, beginning as a Manager in Network Management
and, most recently, as an Assistant Vice President of Teleservices.
 
     The Company's Board of Directors is comprised of six directorships of which
one is currently vacant. All directors of the Company currently hold office
until the next annual meeting of stockholders of the Company or until their
successors are elected and qualified. Prior to completion of the Offerings, the
Board of Directors will be divided into three classes serving staggered,
three-year terms. At each annual meeting of stockholders of the Company,
successors to the class of directors whose term expires at such meeting will be
elected to serve for three-year terms and until their successors are elected and
qualified. Messrs. Peet and Pizzani were elected to the Board of Directors
pursuant to the terms of the COMSAT Shareholders Agreement and the S-C V-Tel
Shareholders Agreement (each as herein defined), respectively. S-C V-Tel's right
to nominate a director to the Company's Board of Directors terminates upon
completion of the Offerings. See "-- Compensation Committee Interlocks and
Insider Participation -- Shareholders Agreements." Executive officers hold
office until their successors are chosen and qualified, subject to earlier
removal by the Board of Directors and subject to the terms of any written
agreements. See "-- Employment, Expatriate and Severance Agreements."
 
     The Board of Directors has established two committees, a Compensation
Committee and an Audit Committee. The current members of the Compensation
Committee are Messrs. Mahoney, Peet and Pizzani and the current members of the
Audit Committee are Messrs. Peet, Pizzani and Shaw. The Compensation Committee
reviews general policy matters relating to compensation and benefits of
employees and officers of the Company and administers the Stock Incentive Plan.
The Audit Committee, which was established in July 1996, will (i) recommend the
appointment of a firm of independent accountants to audit the Company's
financial statements, (ii) discuss the scope and results of the audit with the
independent accountants, (iii) review with management and the independent
accountants the Company's interim and year-end operating results, (iv) consider
the adequacy of the internal controls and audit procedures of the Company and
(v) review the nonaudit services to be performed by the independent accountants.
 
     Currently, the Company's directors do not receive any cash compensation for
their service on the Board of Directors. Following the completion of the
Offerings, non-employee directors will be entitled to receive an annual fee of
$12,000, a meeting fee of $1,000 for every board meeting attended and each
committee meeting held separately and a $500 fee for each board meeting or
committee meeting participated in by telephone. Directors who are also employees
of the Company will not be separately compensated for serving on the Board of
Directors. All directors will be reimbursed for out-of-pocket expenses. Under
the Stock Incentive Plan, the Company may, from time to time and in the
discretion of the Board of Directors, grant options to directors. See "-- Stock
Incentive Plan."
 
                                       46
<PAGE>   50
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
     The following table sets forth certain information concerning compensation
for services in all capacities awarded to, earned by or paid to, the Company's
Chief Executive Officer and the Company's other most highly compensated
executive officers, whose aggregate cash and cash equivalent compensation
exceeded $100,000 (the "Named Executives"), with respect to the last two fiscal
years. The table also identifies the principal capacity in which each of the
Named Executives served the Company at the end of 1995.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       ANNUAL COMPENSATION
                                               -----------------------------------    LONG TERM COMPENSATION
                                                                         OTHER       ------------------------
                                                                         ANNUAL      RESTRICTED   SECURITIES
                                                                      COMPENSATION     STOCK      UNDERLYING
     NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITION       YEAR    SALARY($)   BONUS($)      ($)(1)      AWARDS($)    OPTIONS(#)
- -------------------------------------  -----   ---------   --------   ------------   ----------   -----------
<S>                                    <C>     <C>         <C>        <C>            <C>          <C>
Martin Varsavsky,
  President and Chief Executive
  Officer............................   1995   $ 329,673   $100,000     $ 99,813            --           --
                                        1994     309,345    200,000           --            --           --
Alan L. Levy(2),
  Executive Vice President, Legal and
  Finance............................   1995     165,017    122,248      117,700       117,000(3)        --
                                        1994     111,250    150,000           --                     70,000
                                                                                            --
Ardean Cary(4),
  Executive Vice President, Marketing
  and Sales..........................   1995     110,029         --           --            --           --
                                        1994     123,000    100,000           --            --       35,000
Michael J. Mahoney(5),
  Executive Vice President,
  Operations and Technology; Managing
  Director, Intercontinental.........   1995     123,000    117,607       52,715            --       35,000
                                        1994      59,538     50,000           --            --       35,000
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) The aggregate value of the perquisites and other personal benefits received
     by each Named Executive in 1994 and for Mr. Cary in 1995 have not been
     reflected for such year because the amount was below the Commission's
     required reporting threshold. The amounts reflected in this column for 1995
     include (i) $35,880 of housing allowance expense and $47,500 of relocation
     expense reimbursement for Mr. Varsavsky, (ii) $38,667 of housing allowance
     expense for Mr. Levy and (iii) $23,834 of housing allowance expense for Mr.
     Mahoney.
 
(2) Mr. Levy ceased to be an executive officer of the Company effective July 31,
     1996. See "-- Employment, Expatriate and Severance Agreements."
 
(3) Mr. Levy held a total of 30,000 shares of restricted Common Stock at
     December 31, 1995 having an aggregate market value on such date of
     approximately $117,000. As of such date, such shares were to vest ratably
     over the 36 month period ending December 31, 1997. Dividends, if any, paid
     with respect to vested shares of restricted stock would be paid directly to
     Mr. Levy. In connection with Mr. Levy's separation from the Company, the
     Company vested all unvested shares of restricted stock. See "-- Employment,
     Expatriate and Severance Agreements."
 
(4) Mr. Cary ceased to be an executive officer of the Company effective May 15,
     1995.
 
(5) Mr. Mahoney began his employment with the Company in July 1994.
 
                                       47
<PAGE>   51
 
STOCK OPTION GRANTS
 
     The following table sets forth information regarding grants of options to
purchase shares of Common Stock made by the Company during the year ended
December 31, 1995 to each Named Executive. No SARs were granted to these
individuals during 1995.
 
                             OPTION GRANTS IN 1995
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                          INDIVIDUAL GRANTS                         POTENTIAL REALIZABLE
                        ------------------------------------------------------        VALUE AT ASSUMED
                        NUMBER OF     PERCENT OF                                   ANNUAL RATES OF STOCK
                        SECURITIES   TOTAL OPTIONS                                 PRICE APPRECIATION FOR
                        UNDERLYING    GRANTED TO       EXERCISE                        OPTION TERM(3)
                         OPTIONS     EMPLOYEES IN       PRICE       EXPIRATION     ----------------------
         NAME           GRANTED(#)      1995(1)      ($/SHARE)(2)      DATE         (5%)          (10%)
- ----------------------  ----------   -------------   ------------   ----------     -------       --------
<S>                     <C>          <C>             <C>            <C>            <C>           <C>
Martin Varsavsky......        --            --              --              --          --             --
Alan L. Levy..........        --            --              --              --          --             --
Ardean Cary...........        --            --              --              --          --             --
Michael J. Mahoney....    35,000(4)       13.4%         $ 3.90      01/01/2005     $85,844       $217,546
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) The Company granted options to purchase a total of 261,500 shares of Common
     Stock in 1995.
 
(2) The exercise price was equal to the fair market value of the shares of
     Common Stock underlying the options on the grant date as determined by the
     Board of Directors.
 
(3) Amounts reported in these columns represent amounts that may be realized
     upon exercise of options immediately prior to the expiration of their term
     assuming the specified compounded rates of appreciation (5.0% and 10.0%) on
     the Common Stock over the term of the options. These assumptions are based
     on rules promulgated by the Commission and do not reflect the Company's
     estimate of future stock price appreciation. Actual gains, if any, on the
     stock option exercises and Common Stock holdings are dependent on the
     timing of such exercises and the future performance of the Common Stock.
     There can be no assurance that the rates of appreciation assumed in this
     table can be achieved or that the amounts reflected will be received by the
     option holder.
 
(4) In the event of certain Corporate Transactions (as defined herein), all
     unvested stock options become exercisable, unless assumed by the successor
     corporation or its parent company. See "-- Stock Incentive Plan."
 
     Since January 1, 1996, the Company has granted, pursuant to the terms of
the Stock Incentive Plan, options to purchase an aggregate of 840,940 shares of
Common Stock exercisable at a price of $3.90 per share. Current executive
officers to whom options have been granted during 1996 are as follows: Michael
J. Mahoney, 200,000 options; Allan L. Shaw, 30,000 options; Mark St. J.
Courtney, 30,000 options; Paolo Di Fraia, 30,000 options; and Sheldon M.
Goldman, 20,000 options.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>   52
 
OPTION EXERCISES AND YEAR-END VALUE TABLE
 
     The following table sets forth information regarding the exercise of stock
options during fiscal 1995 and the number and year-end value of unexercised
options held at December 31, 1995, by each of the Named Executives. No stock
options or SARs were exercised by the Named Executives during fiscal 1995.
 
                   AGGREGATE OPTION EXERCISES IN FISCAL 1995
                     AND FISCAL 1995 YEAR-END OPTION VALUES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              NUMBER OF SECURITIES            VALUE OF UNEXERCISED
                                             UNDERLYING UNEXERCISED              "IN-THE-MONEY"
                                                OPTIONS AT FISCAL              OPTIONS AT FISCAL
                                                   YEAR-END(#)                    YEAR-END($)
                   NAME                     EXERCISABLE/UNEXERCISABLE     EXERCISABLE/UNEXERCISABLE(1)
- ------------------------------------------  -------------------------     ----------------------------
<S>                                         <C>                           <C>
Martin Varsavsky..........................             0/0                            $0/$0
Alan L. Levy..............................        46,003/27,223                   71,284/38,384
Ardean Cary...............................        20,417/0                        28,788/0
Michael J. Mahoney........................        31,110/38,890                   26,046/23,304
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Options are "in-the-money" if the fair market value of the underlying
    securities exceeds the exercise price of the options. The amounts set forth
    represent the difference between $3.90 per share, the fair market value of
    the Common Stock issuable upon exercise of options at December 31, 1995 (as
    determined by the Board of Directors), and the exercise price of the option,
    multiplied by the applicable number of options.
 
EMPLOYMENT, EXPATRIATE AND SEVERANCE AGREEMENTS
 
     On September 30, 1993, the Company entered into an employment agreement
with Martin Varsavsky pursuant to which Mr. Varsavsky agreed to serve full time
as Chief Executive Officer of the Company for an annual base salary of $350,000,
payable in accordance with the Company's payroll practices then in effect, less
any applicable withholding or payroll deductions. In addition to his annual
salary, Mr. Varsavsky is eligible for an annual bonus determined by the
Compensation Committee and is also eligible for additional bonuses and such
other incentive compensation programs available generally to executive officers.
Pursuant to an April 5, 1994 amendment to Mr. Varsavsky's employment agreement,
the term of such agreement extends until the earlier of (i) April 4, 1997, (ii)
the date on which neither COMSAT nor S-C V-Tel beneficially owns at least 10.0%
(subject to certain adjustments) of the issued and outstanding Common Stock on a
fully diluted basis and (iii) the agreement's termination in accordance with its
terms. If Mr. Varsavsky's employment is terminated prior to such date by reason
of disability, he will receive a severance payment equal to one year's base
salary. If the Company terminates Mr. Varsavsky's employment with or without
cause during the term of his employment, the Company is required to give him 30
days' prior written notice and is required to pay his base salary for the notice
period. If the Company terminates Mr. Varsavsky's employment without cause and
Mr. Varsavsky agrees to be bound by certain non-competition obligations, then
the Company must pay Mr. Varsavsky the salary to which he otherwise would have
been entitled through September 30, 1996.
 
     In August 1995, the Company entered into an expatriate agreement with
Michael J. Mahoney, pursuant to which Mr. Mahoney agreed to continue as the
Company's Executive Vice President, Operations and Technology for an annual base
salary of $165,000. In addition to his base salary, Mr. Mahoney is eligible for
bonuses, based on operating, business and financial objectives, as well as
qualitative objectives, and other forms of compensation which are generally
available to other senior and executive managers. Mr. Mahoney's employment is
guaranteed through September 30, 1996. If Mr. Mahoney's employment is terminated
other than voluntarily by Mr. Mahoney, as a result of his death or for Cause (as
defined in his expatriate agreement), the Company is required to pay Mr. Mahoney
his
 
                                       49
<PAGE>   53
 
salary through September 30, 1996. In addition, if following a "change of
control" (as defined in the agreement) Mr. Mahoney's position is eliminated or
he elects to leave because the Company has reduced or altered his position, Mr.
Mahoney will be entitled to receive six months salary. Pursuant to the terms of
his expatriate agreement, Mr. Mahoney was compensated for certain costs
attributable to his relocation to and assignment in London and his repatriation
to New York. For purposes of such expatriate agreement, a "change of control" is
deemed to have occurred if: (i) there has been a merger or consolidation in
which the Company is not the surviving entity, other than a transaction the
principal purpose of which is to change the Company's name or state of
incorporation; (ii) the Company sells, transfers or otherwise disposes of all or
substantially all of its assets; (iii) there has occurred a reverse merger in
which the Company is the surviving entity but in which the Company's
stockholders immediately prior to such merger do not hold (by virtue of their
shares in the Company held immediately prior to such transaction) securities of
the Company representing more than 51.0% of the total voting power of the
Company immediately after such transaction.
 
     The Company has entered into a severance agreement, dated July 30, 1996,
with Alan L. Levy, the Company's former Executive Vice President, Legal and
Finance, pursuant to which the Company agreed (i) to make semi-monthly payments,
in the amount of $6,875, to Mr. Levy through January 15, 1997 and a lump sum
payment to him, in the amount of $89,375, on January 31, 1997, in each instance
for consulting services, (ii) to accelerate the vesting of approximately 16,700
restricted shares of Common Stock and options to purchase approximately 9,700
shares of Common Stock so that Mr. Levy would be fully vested in options to
purchase 73,226 shares of Common Stock at an average exercise price of $2.40 per
share and 80,000 shares of Common Stock, each granted pursuant to the Stock
Incentive Plan, and (iii) to file an S-8 Registration Statement covering such
shares of restricted stock and the shares of Common Stock underlying such
options no later than October 31, 1996. In exchange for the foregoing, Mr. Levy
agreed to certain provisions, including non-solicitation and confidentiality
covenants.
 
STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN
 
     The Company has adopted the 1993 Flexible Stock Incentive Plan (the "Stock
Incentive Plan") under which "non-qualified" stock options ("NQSOs") to acquire
shares of Common Stock may be granted to employees, directors and consultants of
the Company and "incentive" stock options ("ISOs") to acquire shares of Common
Stock may be granted to employees and directors. The Stock Incentive Plan also
provides for the grant of SARs and shares of restricted stock to the Company's
employees, directors and consultants.
 
     The Stock Incentive Plan provides for the issuance of up to a maximum of
1,750,000 shares of Common Stock and is currently administered by the
Compensation Committee. Under the Stock Incentive Plan, the option price of any
ISO may not be less than the fair market value of a share of Common Stock on the
date on which the option is granted. The option price of an NQSO may be less
than the fair market value on the date the NQSO is granted if the Compensation
Committee so determines. An ISO may not be granted to a "ten percent
stockholder" (as such term is defined in Section 422A of the Code) unless the
exercise price is at least 110.0% of the fair market value of the Common Stock
and the term of the option may not exceed five years from the date of grant.
Each option granted pursuant to the Stock Incentive Plan is evidenced by a
written agreement executed by the Company and the grantee, which contains the
terms, provisions and conditions of the grant. Stock options may not be assigned
or transferred during the lifetime of the holder except as may be required by
law or pursuant to a qualified domestic relations order. Common Stock subject to
a restricted stock purchase or bonus agreement is transferable only as provided
in such agreement. The maximum term of each stock option granted to persons
other than ten percent stockholders is ten years from the date of grant.
 
     For options to qualify as ISOs, the aggregate fair market value, determined
on the date of grant, of the shares with respect to which the ISOs are
exercisable for the first time by the grantee during any calendar year may not
exceed $100,000. Payment by option holders upon exercise of an option may be
made in cash or, with the consent of the Compensation Committee, in whole or in
part, (i) with shares of
 
                                       50
<PAGE>   54
 
Common Stock, (ii) by irrevocable direction to an approved securities broker to
sell shares and deliver all or a portion of the proceeds to the Company, (iii)
by delivery of a promissory note with such provisions as the Compensation
Committee determines appropriate or (iv) in any combination of the foregoing. In
addition, the Compensation Committee, in its sole discretion, may authorize the
surrender by an optionee of all or part of an unexercised stock option and
authorize a payment in consideration thereof of an amount equal to the
difference between the aggregate fair market value of the shares of Common Stock
subject to such stock option and the aggregate option price per share of such
Common Stock. In the Compensation Committee's discretion, such payment may be
made in cash, shares of Common Stock with a fair market value on the date of
surrender equal to the payment amount or some combination thereof.
 
     The Stock Incentive Plan provides that outstanding options, restricted
shares of Common Stock or SARs vest in their entirety and become exercisable, or
with respect to restricted stock, are released from restrictions on transfer and
repurchase rights, in the event of a "Corporate Transaction." For purposes of
the Stock Incentive Plan, a Corporate Transaction includes any of the following
stockholder-approved transactions to which the Company is a party: (i) a merger
or consolidation in which the Company is not the surviving entity, other than a
transaction the principal purpose of which is to change the state of the
Company's incorporation, or a transaction in which the Company's stockholders
immediately prior to such merger or consolidation hold (by virtue of securities
received in exchange for their shares in the Company) securities of the
surviving entity representing more than 50.0% of the total voting power of such
entity immediately after such transaction; (ii) the sale, transfer or other
disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company unless the
Company's stockholders immediately prior to such sale, transfer or other
disposition hold (by virtue of securities received in exchange for their shares
in the Company) securities of the purchaser or other transferee representing
more than 50.0% of the total voting power of such entity immediately after such
transaction; or (iii) any reverse merger in which the Company is the surviving
entity but in which the Company's stockholders immediately prior to such merger
do not hold (by virtue of their shares in the Company held immediately prior to
such transaction) securities of the Company representing more than 50.0% of the
total voting power of the Company immediately after such transaction. As of July
31, 1996, options to purchase 1,302,949 shares of Common Stock were outstanding
under the Stock Incentive Plan at exercise prices ranging from $.50 to $3.90 per
share.
 
     Promptly after the completion of the Offerings, the Company intends to file
with the Commission a Registration Statement on Form S-8 covering the restricted
shares of Common Stock and the shares of Common Stock underlying options granted
under the Stock Incentive Plan. This registration statement will become
effective immediately upon filing with the Commission. See "Shares Eligible for
Future Sale."
 
COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION
 
     The Board of Directors did not have a Compensation Committee prior to its
establishment in January 1996. As a result, the entire Board of Directors,
including Messrs. Varsavsky, Levy and Mahoney, made all determinations
concerning compensation of executive officers. The current members of the
Compensation Committee are Messrs. Mahoney, Peet and Pizzani. None of the
executive officers of the Company currently serves on the compensation committee
of another entity or any other committee of the board of directors of another
entity performing functions similar to the Compensation Committee. No
interlocking relationships exist between the Company's Board of Directors or its
Compensation Committee and the board of directors or compensation committee of
any other company.
 
     Shareholders Agreements.  S-C V-Tel and Mr. Varsavsky are parties to a
shareholders' agreement (the "S-C V-Tel Shareholders Agreement") pursuant to
which S-C V-Tel has certain rights relating to the appointment of one member of
the Board of Directors, a member of the Board of Directors' Executive Committee,
if any such committee is established, and the agreement of Mr. Varsavsky to
cause the Board of Directors not to take any Major Action (as defined therein)
without the consent of S-C V-Tel. The S-C V-Tel Shareholders Agreement and all
of the rights and obligations of the parties to the agreement terminate upon
consummation of the Offerings.
 
                                       51
<PAGE>   55
 
     On April 5, 1994, Mr. Varsavsky, Juan Manuel Aisemberg and COMSAT entered
into a shareholders' agreement (as subsequently amended, the "COMSAT
Shareholders Agreement"), which contains similar terms to those contained in the
S-C V-Tel Shareholders Agreement, except with respect to COMSAT's rights
regarding the nomination of directors to the Company's Board of Directors and
COMSAT's rights regarding participation in sales of shares of Common Stock by
Mr. Varsavsky. Pursuant to the terms of the COMSAT Shareholders Agreement, so
long as COMSAT beneficially owns at least 10.0% (subject to certain adjustments)
of the issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock on a fully diluted basis,
COMSAT is entitled to representation on the Company's Board of Directors in
proportion to its percentage ownership of Common Stock, subject to a minimum of
one seat, and to designate one member of an Executive Committee of the Board of
Directors, if any such committee is established. In addition, in certain
instances, if Mr. Varsavsky proposes to sell 10.0% or more of the shares of
Common Stock which he owns, COMSAT has the right to sell its shares of Common
Stock in such a transaction on a pro rata basis for the same consideration per
share and on the same terms as Mr. Varsavsky. COMSAT's right to representation
on the Board of Directors and the Executive Committee and its rights regarding
participation in sales of Common Stock survive the completion of the Offerings.
 
     Voting Agreement.  S-C V-Tel and COMSAT are parties to a voting agreement
(the "Voting Agreement"), pursuant to which, at all times that either S-C V-Tel
or COMSAT is entitled to nominate directors to the Company's Board of Directors,
the other party is required to vote its respective shares of Common Stock in
favor of the first party's nominees. The Voting Agreement remains in effect
until the earlier of the dissolution of the Company or the date on which either
S-C V-Tel or COMSAT no longer owns any shares of Common Stock. See "Certain
Transactions -- S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P." and "Certain Transactions -- COMSAT
Investments, Inc." for a description of the registration rights held by each of
S-C V-Tel and COMSAT.
 
                              CERTAIN TRANSACTIONS
 
S-C V-TEL INVESTMENTS, L.P.
 
     Pursuant to the terms of a stock purchase agreement, dated September 30,
1993 (as subsequently amended, the "S-C V-Tel Stock Purchase Agreement"), S-C
V-Tel purchased 2,543,298 shares of Common Stock on October 1, 1993 and 4,108
shares of Common Stock on December 15, 1993 for an aggregate purchase price of
$5 million (the "S-C V-Tel Shares"). In connection with the purchase of the S-C
V-Tel Shares, for consideration in the aggregate amount of $1,000, S-C V-Tel
acquired certain warrants to purchase shares of Common Stock. Such warrants
expired on October 15, 1995.
 
     The terms of the S-C V-Tel Stock Purchase Agreement provide, among other
things, that at any time six months after the date of effectiveness of the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part, S-C V-Tel has the
right to demand registration under the Securities Act of the S-C V-Tel Shares.
Such demand right must be exercised for at least 30.0%, and no more than 70.0%,
of the S-C V-Tel Shares then owned by S-C V-Tel. No earlier than six months
after the effective date of its first demand registration, S-C V-Tel may request
a second demand registration for any remaining S-C V-Tel Shares. The expenses of
such demand registrations, excluding any underwriter's commissions and discounts
relating to the sale of the S-C V-Tel Shares, will be paid by the Company. In
addition, if the Company proposes to register any of its securities under the
Securities Act at any time after the effectiveness of the Registration Statement
of which this Prospectus forms a part, S-C V-Tel will have the right, on up to
four occasions, to include in such registration a maximum of 33 1/3% of the S-C
V-Tel Shares it then owns. The expenses of any such "piggy-back" registration,
excluding any underwriter's commissions and discounts relating to the sale of
the S-C V-Tel Shares and the fees and disbursements of S-C V-Tel's legal
counsel, will be paid by the Company.
 
     As of June 30, 1996, S-C V-Tel is entitled to sell or transfer any of the
S-C V-Tel Shares, without the consent of the Company, provided that the
transferee is not in competition with, or does not otherwise have interests
adverse to, the Company.
 
                                       52
<PAGE>   56
 
     Prior to an initial public offering or sale of all or substantially all of
the assets of the Company or a merger in which the Company is not the surviving
entity, S-C V-Tel has certain rights of first offer on proposed private
offerings of securities by either the Company or any of its subsidiaries and has
certain rights to invest, together with COMSAT, in any joint venture proposed by
the Company. S-C V-Tel also has the right to request that the Company sell all
or substantially all of its assets or merge into another person or entity or
effect an initial public offering, if the Company has not consummated an initial
public offering or sale or merger of the Company on or prior to June 30, 1997.
Such rights of S-C V-Tel will terminate upon the effective date of the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part. See
"Management -- Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider
Participation -- Shareholders Agreements" for a description of certain voting
rights held by S-C V-Tel.
 
COMSAT INVESTMENTS, INC.
 
     Pursuant to the terms of a stock purchase agreement, dated April 5, 1994
(as subsequently amended, the "COMSAT Purchase Agreement"), COMSAT purchased
3,210,808 shares of Common Stock for a purchase price of $8.0 million (the
"COMSAT Shares"). In connection with the purchase of the COMSAT Shares, for
consideration in the aggregate amount of $1,000, COMSAT acquired certain
warrants to purchase shares of Common Stock. Such warrants expired on October
15, 1995.
 
     Pursuant to the terms of the COMSAT Purchase Agreement, COMSAT has been
granted the same demand and piggyback registration rights as S-C V-Tel. The
COMSAT Purchase Agreement further provides that COMSAT may not transfer any
COMSAT Shares to any transferee without first offering such shares to the
Company if, following such transfer, such transferee would own 20.0% or more of
the then outstanding shares of Common Stock. In addition, COMSAT has agreed that
it will not acquire more than 30.0% of the shares of Common Stock outstanding at
any time except in certain circumstances relating to changes in the percentage
of the outstanding Common Stock owned by Mr. Varsavsky. Such 30.0% limitation
does not apply to shares of Common Stock acquired by COMSAT pursuant to any
exercise of its right of first offer described below.
 
     Prior to an initial public offering or sale of all or substantially all of
the assets of the Company or a merger in which the Company is not the surviving
entity, COMSAT has certain rights of first offer on proposed private offerings
of securities by either the Company or any of its subsidiaries, certain rights
to invest in any joint venture proposed by the Company and certain rights of
first offer if S-C V-Tel demands a sale of the Company. Such rights of COMSAT
will terminate upon the effective date of the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus forms a part. See "Management -- Compensation Committee
Interlocks and Insider Participation -- Shareholders Agreements" for a
description of certain voting rights held by COMSAT.
 
                                       53
<PAGE>   57
 
                             PRINCIPAL STOCKHOLDERS
 
     The following table sets forth certain information regarding the beneficial
ownership of the Company's Common Stock, as of August 1, 1996, before and after
giving effect to the Offerings, by (i) each person known by the Company to own
beneficially 5.0% or more of the Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock,
(ii) each director of the Company, (iii) each of the Named Executives, and (iv)
all current executive officers and directors of the Company, as a group. All
information with respect to beneficial ownership has been furnished to the
Company by the respective stockholders of the Company.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    SHARES BENEFICIALLY                 SHARES BENEFICIALLY
                                    OWNED PRIOR TO THE                    OWNED AFTER THE
                                       OFFERINGS(1)                       OFFERINGS(1)(2)
                              -------------------------------     -------------------------------
            NAME                NUMBER                PERCENT       NUMBER                PERCENT
- ----------------------------- -----------             -------     -----------             -------
<S>                           <C>                     <C>         <C>                     <C>
Martin Varsavsky(3)
Parque Empresarial Edificio
  2,
c/o Beatriz De Bobadilla
14,5  Ofic. B
Madrid, Spain................   7,540,000               36.7%       7,540,000                   %
COMSAT Investments, Inc.
6560 Rock Spring Drive
Bethesda, MD 20817...........   3,210,808(4)            15.6        3,210,808(4)
S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P.
888 Seventh Avenue
New York, NY 10106...........   2,547,406(4)            12.4        2,547,406
Juan Manuel Aisemberg(3)
Callao 1801, Buenos Aires,
Argentina 1024...............   1,389,110                6.8        1,389,110
Michael J. Mahoney...........      98,610(5)               *           98,610(5)               *
Alan L. Levy.................     153,226(6)               *          153,226(6)               *
Ardean Cary..................      20,417(7)               *           20,417(7)               *
Allan L. Shaw................      12,222(7)               *           12,222(7)               *
W. James Peet................          --                 --               --                 --
Paul G. Pizzani..............          --                 --               --                 --
All directors and executive
  officers as a group (8
  persons)...................   7,667,222               37.3        7,667,222                 --
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
  * Represents beneficial ownership of less than 1.0% of the outstanding shares
    of Common Stock.
 
 (1) Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the
     Commission. In computing the number of shares of Common Stock beneficially
     owned by a person and the percentage ownership of that person, shares of
     Common Stock subject to options and warrants held by that person that are
     currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of August 1, 1996 are
     deemed outstanding. Such shares, however, are not deemed outstanding for
     the purposes of computing the percentage ownership of any other person.
     Except as indicated in the footnotes to this table, each stockholder named
     in the table has sole voting and investment power with respect to the
     shares set forth opposite such stockholder's name.
 
 (2) Assumes no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option.
 
 (3) Mr. Varsavsky and Mr. Aisemberg are related by marriage.
 
                                       54
<PAGE>   58
 
 (4) Does not include 11,476,516 and 10,750,808 shares of Common Stock,
     respectively, which COMSAT and S-C V-Tel may be deemed to beneficially own
     as a result of certain voting arrangements contained in the Voting
     Agreement, the COMSAT Shareholders Agreement and the S-C V-Tel Shareholders
     Agreement. The S-C V-Tel Shareholders Agreement will terminate upon
     completion of the Offerings. See "Management -- Compensation Committee
     Interlocks and Insider Participation -- Voting Agreement" and
     "Management -- Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider
     Participation -- Shareholders Agreements."
 
 (5) Includes vested options to purchase 48,610 shares of Common Stock which
     options were granted pursuant to the Stock Incentive Plan.
 
 (6) Includes vested options to purchase 73,326 shares of Common Stock which
     options were granted pursuant to the Stock Incentive Plan.
 
 (7) Represents vested options to purchase shares of Common Stock which options
     were granted pursuant to the Stock Incentive Plan.
 
                                       55
<PAGE>   59
 
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
 
GENERAL
 
     Effective upon completion of the Offerings, the Company's authorized
capital stock will consist of (i) 50.0 million shares of Common Stock, par value
$.01 per share (the "Common Stock"), and (ii) 1.0 million shares of Preferred
Stock, par value $.01 per share (the "Preferred Stock"), of which        shares
of Common Stock and no shares of Preferred Stock will be issued and outstanding.
As of August 1, 1996, there were 17 holders of record of 16,204,202 outstanding
shares of Common Stock and 2 holders of record of 4,357,270 outstanding shares
of Class A Common Stock.
 
     The statements under this caption are brief summaries of certain material
provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, the Bylaws, the
Indenture and a Registration Rights Agreement, dated December 15, 1994, among
the Company, Martin Varsavsky and Juan Manuel Aisemberg (the "Founding
Shareholders") and Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (the "Registration Rights
Agreement"), each of which are incorporated by reference as exhibits to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part. Such summaries do not
purport to be complete, and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety
by reference to, such documents.
 
COMMON STOCK
 
     Holders of shares of Common Stock are entitled to one vote per share on all
matters on which the holders of Common Stock are entitled to vote and do not
have any cumulative voting rights. This means that the holders of more than
50.0% of the shares voting for the election of directors can elect all of the
directors if they choose to do so; in such event, the holders of the remaining
shares of Common Stock will not be able to elect any person to the Board of
Directors. Subject to the rights of the holders of shares of any series of
Preferred Stock, holders of Common Stock are entitled to receive ratably such
dividends as may from time to time be declared by the Board of Directors of the
Company out of funds legally available therefor. See "Dividend Policy." Holders
of shares of Common Stock have no preemptive, conversion, redemption,
subscription or similar rights. In the event of a liquidation, dissolution or
winding up of the Company, whether voluntary or involuntary, holders of shares
of Common Stock are entitled to share ratably in the assets of the Company which
are legally available for distribution, if any, remaining after the payment or
provision for the payment of all debts and other liabilities of the Company and
the payment and setting aside for payment of any preferential amount due to the
holders of shares of any series of Preferred Stock. All outstanding shares of
Common Stock are, and all shares of Common Stock offered hereby when issued will
be, upon payment therefor, validly issued, fully-paid and nonassessable.
 
     Delaware law does not require stockholder approval for any issuance of
authorized shares of Common Stock. Such authorized and unissued shares may be
used for a variety of corporate purposes, including future public offerings to
raise additional capital or to facilitate corporate acquisitions. One of the
effects of the existence of unissued and unreserved Common Stock may be to
enable the Board of Directors to issue shares to persons friendly to current
management, which issuance could render more difficult or discourage an attempt
to obtain control of the Company by means of a merger, tender offer, proxy
contest or otherwise, and thereby protect the continuity of the Company's
current management and possibly deprive the stockholders of opportunities to
sell their shares of Common Stock at prices higher than prevailing market
prices.
 
     At present there is no established trading market for the Common Stock. The
Company has filed an application to have the Common Stock approved for quotation
on the Nasdaq National Market under the proposed symbol "VYTL."
 
PREFERRED STOCK
 
     Prior to completion of the Offerings, the Certificate of Incorporation, as
amended, of the Company will be amended and restated to authorize the Board of
Directors of the Company to issue from time to time up to one million shares of
Preferred Stock in one or more series and to fix the rights, designations,
 
                                       56
<PAGE>   60
 
preferences, qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof, including
dividend rights, dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of
redemption, redemption prices, liquidation preferences and the number of shares
constituting any series, without any further action by the stockholders of the
Company. The issuance of Preferred Stock with voting rights could have an
adverse affect on the voting power of holders of Common Stock by increasing the
number of outstanding shares having voting rights. In addition, if the Board of
Directors authorizes Preferred Stock with conversion rights, the number of
shares of Common Stock outstanding could potentially be increased up to the
authorized amount. The issuance of Preferred Stock could decrease the amount of
earnings and assets available for distribution to holders of Common Stock. Any
such issuance could also have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a
change in control of the Company and may adversely affect the rights of holders
of Common Stock. The Board of Directors does not presently intend to issue any
shares of Preferred Stock.
 
CERTAIN PROVISIONS OF THE COMPANY'S CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION, BYLAWS AND
INDENTURE
 
     The Company's Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, provides that no
director of the Company shall be liable to the Company or its stockholders for
monetary damages for breach of his fiduciary duty as a director, except for
liability (i) for any breach of the director's duty of loyalty to the Company or
its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve
intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) in respect of
certain unlawful dividend payments or stock redemptions or repurchases or (iv)
for any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal
benefit. The effect of these provisions is to eliminate the rights of the
Company and its stockholders (through stockholders' derivative suits on behalf
of the Company) to recover monetary damages against a director for breach of
fiduciary duty as a director (including breaches resulting from grossly
negligent behavior), except in the situations described above.
 
     The Company's Bylaws require the Company to indemnify any legal
representative, director or officer of the Company or any person who is or was
serving at the request of the Company as a director, officer, employee or agent
of another corporation or of a partnership, joint venture, trust or other
enterprise, including service with respect to employee benefit plans, to the
fullest extent authorized by the DGCL. The Company has obtained officers' and
directors' liability insurance of $10 million for members of its Board of
Directors and executive officers. In addition to the indemnification provided in
the Company's Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, and Bylaws, the Company
has entered into agreements to indemnify its directors and officers from and
against any Expenses (as defined in the indemnity agreement) incurred by such
person in connection with investigating, defending, serving as a witness in,
participating in (including on appeal), or preparing for any of the foregoing in
any threatened, pending or contemplated action, suit, or proceeding (including
an action by or in the right of the Company), or any inquiry, hearing or
investigation, to the fullest extent permitted by law, as such law may be
amended or interpreted (but only to the extent that such amendment or
interpretation provides for broader indemnification rights). The indemnity
agreement contains certain provisions to ensure that the indemnitee receives the
benefits contemplated by the indemnity agreement in the event of a "change in
control" (as defined in the indemnity agreement) such as the establishment and
funding of a trust in an amount sufficient to satisfy any and all expenses
reasonably anticipated to be incurred by the indemnitee in connection with
investigating, preparing for, participating in and/or defending a proceeding.
 
     Prior to completion of the Offerings, the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation, as amended, and Bylaws will be amended and restated to include
certain provisions which are intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity
and stability in the composition of the Company's Board of Directors and which
may have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a future takeover or
change in control of the Company unless such takeover or change in control is
approved by the Company's Board of Directors. Such provisions may also render
the removal of directors and management more difficult.
 
     The Certificate of Incorporation, as amended and restated, will provide
that the Company's Board of Directors will be divided as equally as possible
into three classes serving staggered three-year terms. The Company's Bylaws will
be amended to include restrictions on who may call a special meeting of
stockholders and to establish advance notice procedures with regard to the
nomination, other than by or
 
                                       57
<PAGE>   61
 
at the direction of the Board of Directors, of candidates for election as
directors and with regard to certain matters to be brought before an annual
meeting of stockholders of the Company. In general, notice must be received by
the Company not less than 120 days prior to the meeting and must contain certain
specified information concerning the person to be nominated or the matter to be
brought before the meeting and concerning the stockholder submitting the
proposal.
 
     The Indenture provides that upon the occurrence of a "Change of Control"
(as defined in the Indenture), the Company will be required to make a Change of
Control Offer (as defined in the Indenture) to purchase all of the Notes issued
and then outstanding under the Indenture at a purchase price equal to 101.0% of
the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon, if any,
to the date of purchase. Under the Indenture, a Change of Control is deemed to
occur when (i) a person or group, other than certain existing stockholders,
becomes the beneficial owner of more than 30.0% of the total voting power of the
then outstanding voting stock of the Company on a fully diluted basis and such
ownership is greater than the amount of voting stock on a fully diluted basis
held by the existing stockholders on such date or (ii) individuals who at the
beginning of any period of two consecutive calendar years constituted the Board
of Directors (together with any new directors whose election to the Board of
Directors or whose nomination for election by the Company's stockholders was
approved by a vote of at least two-thirds of the members of the Board of
Directors then still in office who either were members of the Board of Directors
at the beginning of such period or whose election or nomination for election was
previously so approved) cease for any reason to constitute a majority of the
members of the Board of Directors then in office; provided, however, that in the
case of clause (i) above, a Change of Control will not be deemed to have
occurred if a group becomes the ultimate beneficial owner of more than 30.0% of
the total voting power of the then outstanding voting stock of the Company on a
fully diluted basis so long as a majority of the voting power of the voting
stock of the Company beneficially owned by such group is beneficially owned by
the existing stockholders.
 
DELAWARE ANTI-TAKEOVER LAW
 
     As a Delaware corporation, the Company is subject to the DGCL, including
Section 203. Section 203 of the DGCL prohibits certain transactions between a
Delaware corporation and an "interested stockholder," which is defined as a
person who, together with any affiliates or associates of such person,
beneficially owns, directly or indirectly, 15.0% or more of the outstanding
voting shares of a Delaware corporation. This provision prohibits certain
business combinations (defined broadly to include mergers, consolidations, sales
or other dispositions of assets having an aggregate value in excess of 10.0% of
the consolidated assets of the corporation, and certain transactions that would
increase the interested stockholder's proportionate share ownership in the
corporation) between an interested stockholder and a corporation for a period of
three years after the date the interested stockholder becomes an interested
stockholder, unless (i) prior to the date the interested stockholder becomes an
interested stockholder, the business combination or the transaction by which the
stockholder becomes an interested stockholder is approved by the corporation's
board of directors, (ii) upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in
the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, such stockholder held at
least 85.0% of the voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the
transaction commenced (other than stock held by directors who are also officers
or by certain employee stock plans) or (iii) the business combination is
approved by a majority of the board of directors and at an annual or special
meeting of stockholders, and not by written consent, by the affirmative vote of
66 2/3% of the outstanding voting stock that is not owned by the interested
stockholder.
 
RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS TO SELL
 
     Pursuant to the terms of the Registration Rights Agreement, in the event
that, prior to the earlier of the third anniversary of the closing of the Unit
Offering (December 21, 1997) and the effective date of an initial public
offering of the Common Stock, either or both of the Founding Shareholders, in
one or more related transactions, sell 20.0% or more of the aggregate number of
shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by them to any "person" or "group"
(within the meaning of Section 13(d) or 14(d)(2) of the Securities Exchange Act
of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act")), Holders (as defined in the
 
                                       58
<PAGE>   62
 
Registration Rights Agreement) will have the right to sell a percentage, equal
to the percentage of beneficially owned shares of Common Stock sold by the
Founding Shareholders, of their shares of Common Stock to such person or group
on the same terms and conditions as the Founding Shareholders. In the event
that, prior to the earlier of the third anniversary of the closing of the Unit
Offering (December 21, 1997) and the effective date of an initial public
offering of the Common Stock, each of the Founding Shareholders sells all of the
shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by them (in a bona fide third party
transaction) to any person or group (within the meaning of Section 13(d) or
14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act), the Founding Shareholders may require Holders of
shares of Class A Common Stock to sell all of their shares of Class A Common
Stock to such person or group, on the same terms and conditions as the Founding
Shareholders; provided that such Holders shall not be required to sell their
shares of Class A Common Stock unless such Holders shall receive, in
consideration therefor, cash (in U.S. dollars) or securities traded on a
nationally recognized stock exchange or automated quotation system in the United
States. In the event of any merger, acquisition or consolidation of the Company
in which Holders receive any unregistered security of any entity in exchange for
their Registrable Securities (as defined in the Registration Rights Agreement),
the rights referred to in the immediately preceding sentence remain in effect,
except that such rights relate to such securities of such entity that are
received by such Holders of Registrable Securities. The Founding Shareholders
are required to give Holders of the shares of Class A Common Stock 60 days'
notice of any sale by the Founding Shareholders contemplated by this paragraph.
 
REGISTRATION RIGHTS
 
     Pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company is required,
subject to certain limitations and upon the written request of the Holders of
Registrable Securities, together with any holders of Common Stock, representing
in the aggregate at least 15.0% or more of the outstanding Common Stock, to file
and use its best efforts to cause to become effective under the Securities Act a
registration statement with respect to resales of such shares of Common Stock.
The Holders of Registrable Securities may make such a request at any time or
from time to time (unless a registration statement by the Company has been
declared effective during the preceding 180 days) 180 days after the Company
completes an initial public offering of Common Stock; provided that in no event
may the Holders of Registrable Securities make more than three such requests. If
specified by the Holders of the Registrable Securities to be registered, the
Company shall cause to be filed a shelf registration statement and shall use its
best efforts to keep such shelf registration statement continuously effective
for up to one year. In addition, after a public offering of shares of Common
Stock by the Company, Holders of the Registrable Securities are entitled,
subject to certain limitations, to include their Registrable Securities in a
registration of shares of Common Stock initiated by the Company or other selling
stockholders. In the event the aggregate number of Registrable Securities which
the Holders request the Company to include in any such registration, together
with the shares of Common Stock to be sold by the Company and by any selling
stockholders participating in such registration, exceeds the number of shares
which, in the opinion of the managing underwriter, can be sold in such offering
without materially affecting the offering price of such shares, the number of
Registrable Securities of each such Holder and the shares of Common Stock held
by such selling stockholders to be included in such registration will be reduced
pro rata based on the aggregate number of shares of Common Stock for which
registration has been so requested.
 
     Holders of Registrable Securities are required, to the extent they do not
participate in an initial public offering, not to transfer their Registrable
Securities for a period of 180 days following such initial public offering. The
Company is also obligated to cause the Registrable Securities to be listed on a
recognized securities exchange as soon as practicable after the third
anniversary of the closing of the Unit Offering (December 21, 1997).
 
     The Registration Rights Agreement contains customary provisions whereby the
Company and the Holders of Registrable Securities indemnify and agree to
contribute to the other with regard to losses caused by the misstatement of any
information required to be provided in a registration statement filed
 
                                       59
<PAGE>   63
 
under the Securities Act. The Registration Rights Agreement requires the Company
to pay the expenses associated with any registration, other than sales,
discounts, commissions, transfer taxes and expenses to be paid by underwriters
or as otherwise required by law.
 
TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR
 
     The transfer agent and registrar for the Common Stock is
          , whose address is                               .
 
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock. Sales of a substantial amount of Common Stock in the public market, or
the perception that such sales may occur, could adversely affect the market
price of the Common Stock prevailing from time to time in the public market and
could impair the Company's ability to raise additional capital through the sale
of its equity securities in the future.
 
     Upon completion of the Offerings, the Company will have approximately
          shares of Common Stock outstanding (          if the Underwriters'
over-allotment option is exercised in full), including           shares of
Common Stock offered hereby (          if the Underwriters' over-allotment
option is exercised in full) and 20,561,472 "restricted" shares of Common Stock.
Of the restricted shares held by persons other than "affiliates" of the Company
within the meaning of Rule 144, 1,386,878 shares of Common Stock are currently
eligible for sale under Rule 144, as currently in effect, and an additional
4,357,270 shares of Common Stock will be eligible for sale under Rule 144, as
currently in effect, beginning in December 1997.
 
     The shares of Common Stock offered in the Offerings will be freely
tradeable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act
by persons other than "affiliates" of the Company within the meaning of Rule
144. The holders of restricted shares generally will be entitled to sell these
shares in the public securities market without registration under the Securities
Act to the extent permitted by Rule 144 or any exemption under the Securities
Act.
 
     In general, under Rule 144, as currently in effect, if two years have
elapsed since the later of the date of acquisition of restricted shares from the
Company or any "affiliate" of the Company, the holder is entitled to sell within
any three-month period such number of shares of Common Stock that does not
exceed the greater of 1.0% of the then outstanding shares of Common Stock or the
average weekly trading volume of shares of Common Stock during the four calendar
weeks preceding the date on which notice of the sale is filed with the
Commission. Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to certain restrictions on the
manner of sale, notice requirements and the availability of current public
information about the Company. If three years have elapsed since the holder
acquired the restricted shares from the Company or from any "affiliate" of the
Company, and the holder is deemed not to have been an affiliate of the Company
at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale, such person will be entitled to
sell such Common Stock in the public market under Rule 144(k) without regard to
the volume limitations, manner of sale provisions, public information
requirements or notice requirements. The Commission has proposed an amendment to
Rule 144 to shorten each of the two and three year holding periods by one year.
This proposal, if adopted, would increase the number of shares of Common Stock
eligible for immediate sale following the expiration of the "lock-up period"
described below.
 
     The Company and each of its directors and executive officers and certain
other stockholders have entered into "lock-up" agreements with the Underwriters,
providing that, subject to certain exceptions, they will not, for a period of
    days from the date of this Prospectus, without the prior written consent of
Salomon Brothers Inc, offer, sell or contract to sell, or otherwise dispose of,
directly or indirectly, or announce an offering of, any shares of Common Stock
or any securities convertible into, or exchangeable for, shares of Common Stock,
provided that the Company may issue and sell shares of Common Stock pursuant to
the Stock Incentive Plan. See "Underwriting."
 
                                       60
<PAGE>   64
 
     Promptly after completion of the Offerings, the Company intends to file
with the Commission a Registration Statement on Form S-8, covering the
restricted shares of Common Stock and the shares of Common Stock underlying
options granted under the Stock Incentive Plan. This registration statement will
become effective immediately upon filing with the Commission. As a result, the
shares of Common Stock so registered and acquired pursuant to the Stock
Incentive Plan will be available for sale by non-affiliates in the public
securities market without limitation and by affiliates, subject to the volume
limitations of Rule 144.
 
                                       61
<PAGE>   65
 
                                  UNDERWRITING
 
     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in an underwriting agreement
among the Company and the U.S. Underwriters (the "U.S. Underwriting Agreement"),
the Company has agreed to sell to each of the U.S. Underwriters named below (the
"U.S. Underwriters"), and each of the U.S. Underwriters, for whom Salomon
Brothers Inc is acting as the U.S. representative (the "U.S. Representative"),
has severally agreed to purchase from the Company the number of shares set forth
opposite its name below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          NUMBER
                             U.S. UNDERWRITERS                          OF SHARES
        ------------------------------------------------------------    ----------
        <S>                                                             <C>
        Salomon Brothers Inc........................................
 
                                                                        ----------
                  Total.............................................
                                                                        ============
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has been advised by the U.S. Representative that the several
U.S. Underwriters initially propose to offer such shares of Common Stock to the
public at the public offering price set forth on the cover page of this
Prospectus and to certain dealers at such price less a concession not in excess
of $          per share of Common Stock. The U.S. Underwriters may allow, and
such dealers may re-allow, a concession not in excess of $          per share of
Common Stock to other dealers. After the Offerings, the public offering price
and such concessions may be changed.
 
     The Company has granted to the U.S. Underwriters and the international
underwriters (the "International Underwriters" and, collectively with the U.S.
Underwriters, the "Underwriters") an option, exercisable during the 30-day
period after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to           additional
shares of Common Stock from the Company at the price to public less the
underwriting discount, solely to cover over-allotments. To the extent that the
U.S. Underwriters and the International Underwriters exercise such option, each
of the U.S. Underwriters and the International Underwriters, as the case may be,
will be committed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase a number of option
shares proportionate to such U.S. Underwriter's or International Underwriter's
initial commitment.
 
     The Company has entered into an International Underwriting Agreement with
the International Underwriters named therein, for whom Salomon Brothers
International Limited, is acting as the representative (the "International
Representative"), providing for the concurrent offer and sale of
shares of Common Stock (in addition to the shares covered by the over-allotment
option described above) outside the United States and Canada. Both the U.S.
Underwriting Agreement and the International Underwriting Agreement provide that
the obligations of the U.S. Underwriters and the International Underwriters are
such that if any of the shares of Common Stock are purchased by the U.S.
Underwriters pursuant to the U.S. Underwriting Agreement, or by the
International Underwriters pursuant to the International Underwriting Agreement,
all the shares of Common Stock agreed to be purchased by either the U.S.
Underwriters or the International Underwriters, as the case may be, pursuant to
their respective agreements must be so purchased. The price to public and
underwriting discount per share of Common Stock for the U.S. Offering and the
International Offering will be identical. The closing of the International
Offering is a condition to the closing of the U.S. Offering and the closing of
the U.S. Offering is a condition to the closing of the International Offering.
 
     Each U.S. Underwriter has severally agreed that, as part of the
distribution of the           shares of Common Stock offered by the U.S.
Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing any shares of Common Stock for the
account of anyone other than a United States or Canadian Person and (ii) it has
not offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, any
shares of Common Stock or distribute this Prospectus to any person outside the
United States or Canada or to anyone other than a United States or Canadian
 
                                       62
<PAGE>   66
 
Person. Each International Underwriter has severally agreed that, as part of the
distribution of the           shares of Common Stock by the International
Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing any shares of Common Stock for the
account of any United States or Canadian Person, and (ii) it has not offered or
sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, any shares of Common
Stock or distribute any Prospectus relating to the International Offering to any
person within the United States or Canada or to any United States or Canadian
person.
 
     The foregoing limitations do not apply to stabilization transactions or to
certain other transactions specified in the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters
and International Underwriters. "United States" or "Canadian Person" means any
person who is a national or resident of the United States or Canada, any
corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or Canada or of any political subdivision thereof, and
any estate or trust which is subject to United States or Canadian federal income
taxation, regardless of the source of its income (other than the foreign branch
of any United States or Canadian Person), and includes any United States or
Canadian branch of a person other than a United States or Canadian Person.
 
     Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters and International
Underwriters, sales may be made between the U.S. Underwriters and the
International Underwriters of such number of shares of Common Stock as may be
mutually agreed. The price of any shares of Common Stock so sold shall be the
public offering price, less an amount not greater than the concession to
securities dealers. To the extent that there are sales between the U.S.
Underwriters and the International Underwriters pursuant to the Agreement
Between U.S. Underwriters and International Underwriters, the number of shares
of Common Stock initially available for sale by the U.S. Underwriters or by the
International Underwriters may be more or less than the amount specified on the
cover page of this Prospectus.
 
     Any offer of the shares of Common Stock in Canada will be made only
pursuant to an exemption from the registration and qualification requirements in
any jurisdiction in Canada in which such offer is made.
 
     The U.S. Underwriting Agreement provides that the Company will indemnify
the U.S. Underwriters against certain liabilities and expenses, including
liabilities under the Securities Act, or contribute to payments the U.S.
Underwriters may be required to make in respect thereof.
 
     The Company and each of its directors and executive officers and certain
other stockholders have agreed not to offer, sell, contract to sell or otherwise
dispose of, directly or indirectly, or announce the offering of any shares of
Common Stock, including any such shares beneficially or indirectly owned or
controlled by the Company, or any securities convertible into, or exchangeable
or exercisable for, shares of Common Stock, for        days from the date of
this Prospectus, without the prior written consent of Salomon Brothers Inc,
except for (i) shares issued in connection with any employee benefit or
incentive plans of the Company existing on the date of this Prospectus, (ii)
shares issued in respect of obligations existing before the date of this
Prospectus and (iii) shares issued in connection with the Offerings.
 
     The U.S. Representative does not intend to confirm sales to any account
over which it exercises discretionary authority.
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock. The initial public offering price of the Common Stock will be determined
by negotiation among the Company, the U.S. Representative and the International
Representative. The factors to be considered in determining the initial public
offering price include the information set forth in this Prospectus and
otherwise available to the U.S. Representative and the International
Representative, the history of and future prospects for the industry in which
the Company competes, the ability of the Company's management, the general
conditions of the securities market at the time of the Offerings and the market
prices of securities and certain financial and operating information of
companies engaged in activities similar to those of the Company. There can be no
assurance that the price at which shares of Common Stock will sell in the public
market after the Offerings will not be lower than the price at which they are
sold in the Offerings by the Underwriters.
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   67
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     The validity of the shares of Common Stock will be passed upon for the
Company by Kelley Drye & Warren LLP, New York, New York. Certain legal matters
in connection with the Offerings will be passed upon for the Underwriters by
Cravath, Swaine & Moore, New York, New York.
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
     The consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31,
1995 and 1994 and for each of the years in the three year period ended December
31, 1995 appearing herein and in the Registration Statement have been audited by
KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent Certified Public Accountants, as set forth in
their report appearing elsewhere herein and in the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus forms a part and upon the authority of said firm as
experts in accounting and auditing.
 
                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
     The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement on Form
S-1 under the Securities Act with respect to the shares of Common Stock being
sold in the Offerings. This Prospectus, which constitutes a part of the
Registration Statement, does not contain all the information set forth in the
Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedule thereto, certain portions
of which have been omitted as permitted by the rules and regulations of the
Commission. For further information with respect to the Company and the Common
Stock, reference is made to the Registration Statement and the exhibits and
schedule filed as a part thereof. Statements contained in the Prospectus as to
the contents of any contract, agreement or other document referred to are brief
summaries of the material provisions thereof but are not necessarily complete,
and in each instance reference is made to the copy of such contract, agreement
or other document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, each such
statement being qualified in all respects by such reference. The Registration
Statement, including exhibits and the schedule thereto, may be inspected without
charge at the Commission's principal office at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Judiciary
Plaza, Room 1024, Washington, D.C. 20549 and at the following regional offices
of the Commission: Citicorp Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400,
Chicago, Illinois 60661-2511 and at Seven World Trade Center, Suite 1300, New
York, New York 10048. Copies of all or any portion of the Registration Statement
may be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the Commission at 450 Fifth
Street, N.W., Judiciary Plaza, Washington, D.C. 20549, upon payment of fees
prescribed by the Commission.
 
     The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange
Act and, in accordance therewith, files periodic reports and other information
with the Commission at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Judiciary Plaza, Washington, D.C.
20549. Copies of the reports and information so filed can be inspected without
charge at the public reference facility and regional offices referred to above.
Copies of such material can also be obtained from the Public Reference Section
of the Commission, upon payment of fees prescribed by the Commission.
 
     The Commission maintains a Web site that contains reports, proxy statements
and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the
Commission. The address of the Commission's Web site is http://www.sec.gov.
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   68
 
                                    GLOSSARY
 
     Callback -- A form of dial up access. Viatel offers callback services
utilizing "Code Calling" (a caller dials an Omaha, Nebraska telephone number
which uniquely identifies the caller), Internet Access or X.25 access. The
Company provides both "anywhere to anywhere" calling and virtual private network
calling via Callback access.
 
     CLEC (competitive local exchange carrier) -- A company that provides its
customers with an alternative to the local exchange carrier for local transport
of private line and special access telecommunications services.
 
     CUG (closed user group) -- A group of specified users of a voice or data
network that is assigned a facility that permits them to communicate with each
other, but precludes communications with other users of the service.
 
     Dedicated access -- A means of accessing the Company's network through the
use of a permanent point to point circuit typically leased from the ITO. The
advantage of dedicated access is simplified premises to anywhere calling, faster
call setup times and potentially lower access costs (provided there is
sufficient traffic over the circuit to generate economies of scale).
 
     Dedicated leased line -- Any circuit (typically supplied by and leased from
an ITO designated to be at the exclusive disposal of a given subscriber.
 
     Dialup access -- A form of service rendering whereby access to the Viatel
Network is obtained by means of dialing an ITF, NTF or paid local access number.
Currently, all of the Company's services except ViaCALL Plus are offered via
this access method.
 
     Direct access -- Access to the Company's services using a dedicated leased
line from the customer's premises to the Company's switch.
 
     Facilities-based carrier -- A carrier which owns long distance
interexchange and transmission facilities and originates and terminates calls
through local exchange systems.
 
     IPLC (international private line circuit) -- A permanent international
point-to-point connection for voice and dial-up data.
 
     IRU -- Indefeasible right of use.
 
     ISDN -- Integrated services digital network.
 
     ITF -- International toll-free (a form of dialup access).
 
     ITO -- "Incumbent telecommunications operator" or "incumbent TO" previously
known as the Postal, Telephone and Telegraph company or PTT.
 
     LCR (least cost routing) -- Routing of calls in the least expensive manner.
 
     Local connectivity -- Physical circuits connecting the Company's switches
to the ITO.
 
     Local exchange -- A geographic area determined by the appropriate
regulatory authority in which calls generally are transmitted without toll
charges to the calling or called party.
 
     NTF -- National toll-free (a form of dialup access).
 
     PLC (private line circuit) -- A permanent in-country point-to-point
connection for voice and dial-up data.
 
     POPs (points of presence) -- Locations where a long distance carrier has
installed transmission equipment in a service area that serves as, or relays
calls to, a network switching center of that long distance carrier.
 
     PSTN (public switched telephone network) -- An abbreviation used by the
ITU, PSTN refers to the local phone company.
 
                                       G-1
<PAGE>   69
 
     Private line -- A dedicated telecommunications connection between end user
locations.
 
     Resale -- Resale by a provider of telecommunications services (such as a
local exchange carrier) of such services to other providers or carriers on a
wholesale or a retail basis.
 
     Settlement agreement -- A method by which revenues are distributed between
international long distance telecommunications companies.
 
     SNMP -- Simplified network management protocol, the defacto network
management standard for wide area voice and data networks.
 
     SS7 (signaling system 7) -- The standard signaling protocol currently in
use.
 
     Switch -- A device that opens or closes circuits or selects the paths or
circuits to be used for transmission of information. Switching is a process of
interconnecting circuits to form a transmission path between users.
 
     Virtual private networks -- Carrier provided services which provide
capabilities similar to those of private lines, such as conditioning, error
testing, and higher speed, full-duplex, four wire transmission with a line
quality adequate for data.
 
     Voice Telephony -- The commercial provision for the public of the direct
transport and switching of speech in real-time between public switched network
termination points, enabling any user to use equipment connected to such a
network termination point in order to communicate with another termination
point.
 
     X.25 -- A form of packet switching (a system whereby messages are broken
down into smaller units called packets which are then individually addressed and
routed through the network). The Company uses X.25 packet switching as a means
of originating callback requests.
 
                                       G-2
<PAGE>   70
 
                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        PAGE
                                                                                        -----
<S>                                                                                     <C>
Independent Auditors' Report..........................................................  F-2
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1995 and 1994..........................  F-3
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and
  1993................................................................................  F-4
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' (Deficit) Equity for the Years ended December
  31, 1995, 1994 and 1993.............................................................  F-5
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and
  1993................................................................................  F-6
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the Years ended December 31, 1995, 1994
  and 1993............................................................................  F-7
Consolidated Balance Sheet as of March 31, 1996 (Unaudited)...........................  F-17
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Three Months ended March 31, 1996 and
  1995 (Unaudited)....................................................................  F-18
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Three Months ended March 31, 1996 and
  1995 (Unaudited)....................................................................  F-19
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the Three Months ended March 31, 1996
  and 1995 (Unaudited)................................................................  F-20
</TABLE>
 
                                       F-1
<PAGE>   71
 
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
 
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Viatel, Inc. and Subsidiaries
 
     We have audited the consolidated balance sheets of Viatel, Inc. and
Subsidiaries as of December 31, 1995 and 1994 and the consolidated statements of
operations, stockholders' (deficit) equity and cash flows for each of the years
in the three-year period ended December 31, 1995. These consolidated financial
statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial
statements.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of
Viatel, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the results
of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year
period ended December 31, 1995, in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles.
 
                                          KPMG PEAT MARWICK LLP
 
New York, New York
March 8, 1996
 
                                       F-2
<PAGE>   72
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                           DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1994
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   1995             1994
                                                               ------------     ------------
<S>                                                            <C>              <C>
                                           ASSETS
Current Assets:
  Cash and cash equivalents..................................  $  8,934,914     $ 66,761,614
  Marketable securities, current.............................    25,004,050               --
  Trade accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful
     accounts of $473,000 and $475,000, respectively.........     4,723,664        3,844,595
  Other receivables..........................................     2,757,675          662,885
  Prepaid expenses...........................................       742,803          263,353
                                                               ------------     ------------
          Total current assets...............................    42,163,106       71,532,447
Marketable securities, non-current...........................     1,127,442               --
Property and equipment, net..................................    15,715,121        6,933,462
Deferred financing and registration fees, less accumulated
  amortization of $364,000 and $14,000, respectively.........     3,431,540        3,321,015
Intangible assets, net.......................................     2,070,055        1,904,414
Other assets.................................................     1,106,182          232,132
                                                               ------------     ------------
                                                               $ 65,613,446     $ 83,923,470
                                                               ============     ============
                       LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' (DEFICIT) EQUITY
Current Liabilities:
  Accrued telecommunications costs...........................  $ 11,056,235     $  7,754,580
  Accounts payable and other accrued expenses................     4,591,628        3,327,355
  Commissions payable........................................       300,655          233,558
  Notes payable, current portion.............................            --          966,755
  Current installments of obligations under capital leases...            --          700,865
                                                               ------------     ------------
          Total current liabilities..........................    15,948,518       12,983,113
                                                               ------------     ------------
Long term liabilities:
  Senior discount notes, less discount of $53,416,992 and
     $62,349,523, respectively...............................    67,283,008       58,350,477
  Accrued telecommunications costs, less current portion.....            --          999,463
  Obligations under capital leases, excluding current
     installments............................................            --          605,587
                                                               ------------     ------------
          Total long term liabilities........................    67,283,008       59,955,527
                                                               ------------     ------------
Commitments and contingencies
Stockholders' (deficit) equity:
  Common Stock, $.01 par value. Authorized 50,000,000 shares,
     issued and outstanding 16,104,202 and 16,074,202 shares,
     respectively............................................       161,042          160,742
  Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value. Authorized 10,000,000
     shares, issued and outstanding 4,357,270................        43,573           43,573
  Additional paid-in capital.................................    30,030,805       29,914,105
  Unearned compensation......................................       (78,000)              --
  Cumulative translation adjustment..........................      (164,676)           1,523
  Accumulated deficit........................................   (47,610,824)     (19,135,113)
                                                               ------------     ------------
          Total stockholders' (deficit) equity...............   (17,618,080)      10,984,830
                                                               ------------     ------------
                                                               $ 65,613,446     $ 83,923,470
                                                               ============     ============
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                       F-3
<PAGE>   73
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        1995           1994          1993
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
<S>                                                 <C>            <C>            <C>
Telecommunications revenue........................  $ 32,313,293   $ 26,267,741   $21,392,967
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Operating expenses:
  Costs of telecommunications services............    27,648,340     22,952,941    18,159,410
  Selling expenses................................     7,467,874      4,458,910     2,389,314
  General and administrative expense..............    16,859,663      9,858,881     6,068,655
  Depreciation and amortization...................     2,636,787        789,359       110,892
  Equipment impairment loss.......................       560,419             --            --
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
          Total operating expenses................    55,173,083     38,060,091    26,728,271
Other income (expenses):
  Interest income.................................     3,281,926        213,611        21,432
  Interest expense................................    (8,856,317)      (771,782)           --
  Share in loss of affiliate......................       (41,530)      (144,867)     (141,903)
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
          Net loss................................  $(28,475,711)  $(12,495,388)  $(5,455,775)
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
          Net loss per common share...............  $      (1.39)  $      (0.81)  $     (0.51)
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
          Weighted average common shares
            outstanding...........................    20,461,472     15,357,889    10,638,991
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
</TABLE>
 
        See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
 
                                       F-4
<PAGE>   74
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' (DEFICIT) EQUITY
                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   NUMBER
                                     OF
                      NUMBER OF    CLASS A
                        COMMON     COMMON              CLASS A  ADDITIONAL                 CUMULATIVE
                        STOCK       STOCK     COMMON   COMMON     PAID-IN      UNEARNED    TRANSLATION ACCUMULATED
                        SHARES     SHARES     STOCK     STOCK     CAPITAL    COMPENSATION  ADJUSTMENT    DEFICIT        TOTAL
                      ----------  ---------  --------  -------  -----------  ------------  ----------  ------------  ------------
<S>                   <C>         <C>        <C>       <C>      <C>          <C>           <C>         <C>           <C>
Balance at January
  1,
  1993..............   9,628,000         --  $ 96,280  $   --   $   (51,383)   $     --    $      --   $(1,183,950 ) $ (1,139,053)
Issuance of common
  stock and
  warrants, net of
  $381,804 issue
  costs.............   2,547,406         --    25,474      --     4,593,722          --           --            --      4,619,196
Issuance of common
  stock.............     629,160         --     6,292      --     1,754,305          --           --            --      1,760,597
Issuance of common
  stock, in lieu of
  payment of
  services..........      38,667         --       386      --        38,461          --           --            --         38,847
Issuance of
  restricted common
  stock.............      20,161         --       202      --        49,798     (36,100)          --            --         13,900
Net loss............          --         --        --      --            --          --           --    (5,455,775 )   (5,455,775)
                      ----------- ---------- --------  -------  -----------     -------    ---------   ------------  ------------
Balance at December
  31, 1993..........  12,863,394         --   128,634      --     6,384,903     (36,100)          --    (6,639,725 )     (162,288)
Issuance of common
  stock and
  warrants, net of
  $412,338 issue
  costs.............   3,210,808         --    32,108      --     7,556,554          --           --            --      7,588,662
Issuance of Class A
  common stock, net
  of $977,132 issue
  costs.............          --  4,357,270        --  43,573    15,972,648          --           --            --     16,016,221
Recognition of
  unearned
  compensation......          --         --        --      --            --      36,100           --            --         36,100
Foreign currency
  translation
  adjustment........          --         --        --      --            --          --        1,523            --          1,523
Net loss............          --         --        --      --            --          --           --   (12,495,388 )  (12,495,388)
                      ----------- ---------- --------  -------  -----------     -------    ---------   ------------  ------------
Balance at December
  31, 1994..........  16,074,202  4,357,270   160,742  43,573    29,914,105          --        1,523   (19,135,113 )   10,984,830
Issuance of
  restricted common
  stock.............      30,000         --       300      --       116,700     (78,000)          --            --         39,000
Foreign currency
  translation
  adjustment........          --         --        --      --            --          --     (166,199 )          --       (166,199)
Net loss............          --         --        --      --            --          --           --   (28,475,711 )  (28,475,711)
                      ----------- ---------- --------  -------  -----------     -------    ---------   ------------  ------------
Balance at December
  31, 1995..........  16,104,202  4,357,270  $161,042  $43,573  $30,030,805    $(78,000)   $(164,676 ) $(47,610,824) $(17,618,080)
                      =========== ========== ========  =======  ===========     =======    =========   ============  ============
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                       F-5
<PAGE>   75
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                  YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        1995           1994          1993
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
<S>                                                 <C>            <C>            <C>
Cash flows from operating activities:
  Net loss........................................  $(28,475,711)  $(12,495,388)  $(5,455,775)
  Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash
     used in operating activities:
     Deferred financing and registration costs....      (460,032)    (3,335,015)           --
     Equipment impairment loss....................       560,419             --            --
     Depreciation and amortization................     2,636,787        789,359       110,892
     Interest expense on senior discount notes....     8,773,438        364,506            --
     Accrued interest income on marketable
       securities.................................      (714,468)            --            --
     Provision for losses on accounts
       receivable.................................     1,229,473        900,094       703,000
     Share in loss of affiliate...................        41,530        144,867       141,903
     Unearned compensation........................        39,000         36,100        13,900
  Changes in assets and liabilities:
     Increase in accounts receivable..............    (2,127,611)    (1,052,611)   (2,728,373)
     Increase in prepaid expenses and other
       receivables................................    (2,593,863)      (540,125)     (223,354)
     Increase in other assets and intangible
       assets.....................................      (991,345)        (9,273)      (76,937)
     Increase in accrued telecommunications costs,
       accounts payable, accrued expenses and
       commissions payable........................     3,592,930      3,626,126     6,072,247
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
          Net cash used in operating activities...   (18,489,453)   (11,571,360)   (1,442,497)
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Cash flows from investing activities:
  Purchase of property, equipment and software....   (11,377,850)    (3,671,811)   (1,090,102)
  Purchase of sales organizations.................            --     (1,171,320)           --
  Purchase of Sitel assets........................            --             --    (1,553,350)
  Purchase of marketable securities...............   (55,495,423)            --            --
  Proceeds from maturity of marketable
     securities...................................    30,078,399             --            --
  Investment in affiliate.........................      (262,214)      (152,439)     (305,257)
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
          Net cash used in investing activities...   (37,057,088)    (4,995,570)   (2,948,709)
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Cash flows from financing activities:
  Payments under capital leases...................    (1,306,453)      (620,979)      (51,258)
  Repayment of notes payable......................      (999,463)    (3,000,000)           --
  Proceeds from issuance of senior discount
     notes........................................            --     57,999,971            --
  Proceeds from issuance of Class A Common
     Stock........................................            --     16,016,221            --
  Proceeds from issuance of Common Stock and
     warrants.....................................            --      7,588,662     6,379,793
  Borrowings on notes payable.....................            --      3,000,000            --
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
          Net cash (used in) provided by financing
            activities............................    (2,305,916)    80,983,875     6,328,535
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash..........        25,757         17,212            --
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash
  equivalents.....................................   (57,826,700)    64,434,157     1,937,329
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year....    66,761,614      2,327,457       390,128
                                                    ------------   ------------   -----------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year..........  $  8,934,914   $ 66,761,614   $ 2,327,457
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
  Interest paid...................................  $     58,040   $    425,608   $        --
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
  Equipment acquired under capital lease
     obligations..................................  $         --   $    595,000   $ 1,479,411
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
  Common Stock issued in lieu of payment for
     services.....................................  $         --   $         --   $    38,847
                                                    ============   ============   ===========
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                       F-6
<PAGE>   76
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
  (a) Description of Business
 
     Viatel, Inc. (the "Company") provides value-added telecommunications
services primarily to businesses operating internationally. In order to
effectuate a reincorporation in the State of Delaware, VIA USA, Ltd. (a
predecessor Colorado corporation) merged with and into its wholly owned
subsidiary, Viatel, Inc., on October 11, 1994. The surviving entity, Viatel,
Inc., has reflected all assets and liabilities at historical cost.
 
  (b) Principles of Consolidation
 
     The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company
and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All significant inter-company balances and
transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. Investments in affiliates in
which the Company has significant influence but does not exercise control are
accounted for under the equity method.
 
  (c) Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
     The Company's policy is to maintain its uninvested cash at minimum levels.
Cash equivalents, which include highly liquid debt instruments purchased with a
maturity of three months or less, were $3,116,218 and $63,111,992 at December
31, 1995 and 1994, respectively.
 
  (d) Revenue
 
     The Company records telecommunications revenue as earned, at the time
services are provided.
 
  (e) Cost of Telecommunications Services and Selling Expenses
 
     Cost of telecommunications services is recognized as incurred and consist
of charges for switched long distance services and costs of leased lines.
Selling expenses included commissions to sales representatives in the countries
in which the Company does not operate its own sales organizations. Commission
expense is recorded net of chargebacks for amounts deemed uncollectible in the
period the related services are provided.
 
  (f) Property and Equipment
 
     Property and equipment consist principally of telecommunications related
equipment such as switches, remote nodes and related computer software and is
stated at cost. Equipment acquired under capital leases is stated at the present
value of the future minimum lease payments.
 
     Depreciation is provided using the straight-line method over the estimated
useful lives of the related assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized over
the life of the lease or useful life of the improvement, whichever is shorter.
The estimated useful lives are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                                     <C>
     Communications system................................................   5 to 7 years
     Leasehold improvements...............................................   2 to 5 years
     Furniture, equipment and other.......................................   5 years
     Maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.
</TABLE>
 
                                       F-7
<PAGE>   77
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
  (g) Intangible Assets
 
     Goodwill, which represents the excess of purchase price over fair value of
net assets acquired, is amortized on a straight-line basis over the expected
periods to be benefited, seven years.
 
     Rights to territorial exclusivity represents the period of territory
exclusivity previously granted to the independent sales organizations which were
acquired and is being amortized over three years.
 
     Deferred financing fees represent debt financing costs which are being
amortized over the term of the related debt.
 
     The costs of all other intangible assets are being amortized over their
useful lives, ranging from one to five years.
 
     The Company's intangible assets are assessed for recoverability at least
quarterly. The Company assesses the recoverability of its intangible assets by
determining whether the amortization of the goodwill balance over its remaining
life can be recovered through projections of undiscounted future operating cash
flows of the related intangible assets. The amount of intangible asset
impairment, if any, is measured based on projected discounted future operating
cash flows using a discount rate reflecting the Company's average cost of funds.
The assessment of the recoverability of intangible assets will be impacted if
estimated future operating cash flows are not achieved.
 
  (h) Income Taxes
 
     Effective January 1, 1993, the Company adopted the provisions of Statement
of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes." Under
the asset and liability method of Statement 109, deferred tax assets and
liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to
differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets
and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit
carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted
tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those
temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. Under Statement
109, the effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates
is recognized in income or expense in the period that includes the enactment
date. Adoption of Statement 109 did not have a material impact on the financial
statements of the Company.
 
  (i) Foreign Currency Translation
 
     Foreign currency assets and liabilities are translated using the exchange
rates in effect at the balance sheet date. Results of operations are translated
using the average exchange rates prevailing throughout the year. The effects of
exchange rate fluctuations on translating foreign currency assets and
liabilities into U.S. dollars are accumulated as part of the foreign currency
translation adjustment in stockholders' equity. Gains and losses from foreign
currency transactions are included in general and administrative expense in the
period in which they occur. For the years ending December 31, 1995, 1994 and
1993, the Company experienced $107,846 and $15,324 in foreign exchange
transaction gains and $62,558 in foreign exchange transaction losses,
respectively.
 
  (j) Net Loss Per Share
 
     Net loss per common and common equivalent share is based on the weighted
average number of common shares outstanding during the year. No effect has been
given to common stock equivalents as they are antidilutive.
 
                                       F-8
<PAGE>   78
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES -- (CONTINUED)
  (k) Concentration of Credit Risk
 
     Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to concentration
of credit risk consist primarily of temporary cash investments and trade
receivables. The Company restricts investment of temporary cash investments to
financial institutions with high credit standing. Credit risk on trade
receivables is minimized as a result of the large and diverse nature of the
Company's worldwide customer base.
 
  (l) Reclassifications
 
     Certain reclassifications have been made to the prior year's financial
statements to conform to the current year's presentation.
 
  (m) Use of Estimates
 
     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting
period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
  (n) Additional Accounting Policies
 
     Additional accounting policies are incorporated into the notes herein.
 
(2) ACQUISITIONS
 
     During December 1994, the Company acquired all of the issued and
outstanding stock of two of its independent sales organizations. These
acquisitions have been accounted for under the purchase method of accounting
and, accordingly, the aggregate purchase price of $1,171,320 has been allocated
to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, based upon their estimated fair
values as of the acquisition date. Additionally, the results of operations of
these organizations are included in the consolidated statements of operations
from dates of acquisition. Included among the assets acquired are intangible
assets related to rights to territorial exclusivity which will be amortized over
three years, which corresponds to the remaining period of territory exclusivity
previously granted to the sales organizations. The allocation of the aggregate
purchase price is summarized as follows:
 
<TABLE>
     <S>                                                                      <C>
     Current assets........................................................   $  161,486
     Current liabilities...................................................     (232,865)
     Property and equipment................................................      102,922
     Intangible and other assets acquired..................................    1,139,777
                                                                              ----------
               Total purchase price........................................   $1,171,320
                                                                              ==========
</TABLE>
 
     Due to the nature of the organizations acquired, pro forma revenue would
equal reported revenue and the pro forma net loss would be $194,007 and $48,387
higher than the reported net loss for the years ended December 31, 1994 and
1993, respectively, assuming the acquisitions occurred on January 1, 1993.
 
                                       F-9
<PAGE>   79
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(3) INVESTMENTS IN DEBT SECURITIES
 
     Management determines the appropriate classification of its investments in
debt securities at the time of purchase and reevaluates such determination at
each balance sheet date. These investments are diversified among high credit
quality securities in accordance with the Company's investment policy. Debt
securities that the Company has both the intent and ability to hold to maturity
are carried at amortized cost. Debt securities for which the Company does not
have the intent or ability to hold to maturity are classified as available for
sale. Securities available for sale are carried at fair value, with the
unrealized gains and losses, net of tax, reported in a separate component of
stockholders' equity. At December 31, 1995, the Company had no investments that
qualified as trading.
 
     The amortized cost of debt securities classified as held to maturity and
available for sale are adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of
discounts to maturity over the estimated life of the security. Such amortization
and interest are included in interest income.
 
     The following is a summary of the fair value of securities held to maturity
and securities available for sale at December 31, 1995:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               SECURITIES     SECURITIES
                                                HELD TO        AVAILABLE
                                                MATURITY       FOR SALE          TOTAL
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
     <S>                                       <C>            <C>             <C>
     Money market instruments................  $1,402,562     $        --     $ 1,402,562
     Federal agencies obligations............          --       5,786,796       5,786,796
     Corporate debt securities...............          --      18,942,134      18,942,134
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
               Total.........................  $1,402,562     $24,728,930     $26,131,492
                                               ==========     ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
     The fair value of each investment approximates the amortized cost, and,
therefore, there are no unrealized gains or losses as of December 31, 1995.
 
     The fair value of debt securities held to maturity and securities available
for sale at December 31, 1995 by contractual maturity are shown below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               SECURITIES     SECURITIES
                                                HELD TO        AVAILABLE
                                                MATURITY       FOR SALE          TOTAL
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
     <S>                                       <C>            <C>             <C>
     Due within one year.....................  $1,402,562     $23,601,488     $25,004,050
     Due after one year through two years....          --       1,127,442       1,127,442
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
               Total.........................  $1,402,562     $24,728,930     $26,131,492
                                               ==========     ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
     Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because
borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call
or prepayment penalties.
 
     There were no changes in the classification of any securities held to
maturity or securities available for sale from the time of purchase to the time
of maturity or sale.
 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>   80
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(4) PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
 
     Property and equipment consists of the following as of December 31:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1995            1994
                                                              -----------     ----------
     <S>                                                      <C>             <C>
     Communications system..................................  $13,997,966     $5,495,396
     Leasehold improvements.................................    1,062,742        107,331
     Furniture, equipment and other.........................    2,755,600        960,678
     Construction in progress...............................      679,935      1,142,835
                                                              -----------     ----------
                                                               18,496,243      7,706,240
     Less accumulated depreciation and amortization.........    2,781,122        772,778
                                                              -----------     ----------
                                                              $15,715,121     $6,933,462
                                                              ===========     ==========
</TABLE>
 
     At December 31, 1995 and 1994, construction in progress represents a
portion of the current expansion of the European Network. As of December 31,
1995, $508,600 of interest has been capitalized with respect to this project.
 
(5) INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
     Intangible assets consist of the following as of December 31:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1995            1994
                                                              -----------     ----------
     <S>                                                      <C>             <C>
     Rights to territorial exclusivity......................  $ 1,607,225     $1,091,451
     Goodwill...............................................      474,065        474,065
     Purchased software.....................................      661,999        418,756
     Other..................................................      133,834         67,668
                                                              -----------     ----------
                                                                2,877,123      2,051,940
     Less accumulated amortization..........................      807,068        147,526
                                                              -----------     ----------
                                                              $ 2,070,055     $1,904,414
                                                              ===========     ==========
</TABLE>
 
(6) LONG TERM LIABILITIES
 
  (a) Senior Discount Notes
 
     On December 21, 1994, the Company issued $120,700,000, representing the
aggregate principal amount, of 15% senior unsecured discount notes due January
15, 2005 for approximately $58,000,000. The notes will fully accrete on a
semiannual compounding basis to face value on January 15, 2000 with semiannual
interest payments commencing July 15, 2000 until maturity.
 
     The notes are redeemable at the Company's option, in whole or in part, at
any time on or after January 15, 2000 until maturity at redemption prices that
range from 110% to 100% of the notes face value plus accrued interest. In
addition, at any time prior to January 15, 1998, the Company may redeem up to
$42,245,000 of the face value of the notes with the proceeds of one or more
public equity offerings at 115% of the then accreted value of the notes, plus
accrued interest, if any, to the redemption date. Upon a change of control, the
Company is required to make an offer to purchase the notes at a purchase price
equal to 101% of their principal amount, plus accrued interest, if any. The
notes contain certain covenants that, among other things, limit the ability of
the Company and certain of its subsidiaries to incur indebtedness, make
pre-payments of certain indebtedness and pay dividends.
 
                                      F-11
<PAGE>   81
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(6) LONG TERM LIABILITIES -- (CONTINUED)
     On December 31, 1995, the Company estimated the fair value of these notes
to be $67,300,000 which approximates its accreted value. The estimate is based
on quoted market prices for the notes.
 
  (b) Note Payable -- MCI
 
     On January 28, 1994, the Company converted $2,666,755 of its outstanding
balance to MCI Telecommunications Corporation as of December 31, 1993 to a 7%
note secured by the Company's accounts receivable. At December 31, 1994,
$966,755 was outstanding under this note and was included in notes payable,
current. At December 31, 1995, the note was no longer outstanding.
 
(7) STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
 
     During 1993, the Company increased the number of its authorized shares of
voting, no par value Common Stock from 100 to 20,000,000. In addition, the Board
of Directors authorized a recapitalization of the amount of its issued and
outstanding Common Stock by means of a 96,666 2/3 to 1 stock split. On March 21,
1994, the Company increased the number of its authorized shares of no par value
Common Stock from 20,000,000 to 50,000,000. On October 11, 1994, the Company
changed its voting Common Stock from no par value to $.01 par value per share.
All Common Stock and additional paid-in capital amounts have been restated to
reflect these changes.
 
     In lieu of cash payments for call switching, initial screening, account
establishment and billing services, the Sitel Corporation received 2% of the
issued and outstanding Common Stock of the Company based on a market valuation
of $10,000,000. Of these shares, 80% were issued and outstanding at December 31,
1992 and the remaining 20% was issued during February 1993.
 
     On October 1, 1993, the Company issued 2,547,406 shares of its Common Stock
for $5,000,000 and warrants to purchase additional shares of Common Stock. As of
December 31, 1995, the warrants have expired and are no longer exercisable.
Additionally, certain rights of the Company to repurchase a portion of the
shares have expired. Certain of such shares are subject to certain registration
rights in the event of public offerings by the Company.
 
     On April 5, 1994, the Company issued 3,210,808 shares of its Common Stock
for $8,000,000 and warrants to purchase additional shares of Common Stock. As of
December 31, 1995, the warrants have expired and are no longer exercisable.
Additionally, certain rights of the Company to repurchase a portion of the
shares have expired. Certain of such shares are subject to certain registration
rights in the event of public offerings by the Company.
 
     On December 16, 1994, the Company authorized the creation of 10,000,000
shares of non-voting, $.01 par value, Class A Common Stock. On December 21,
1994, 4,357,270 shares of Class A Common Stock were issued for net proceeds of
$16,016,221. Each share of Class A Common Stock will automatically convert after
October 15, 1995 into one share of Common Stock upon the earlier of an initial
public offering of the Common Stock or the third anniversary of its initial sale
by the Company. Except for voting and the above described anti-dilution rights,
the rights of holders are substantially identical to those of Common
Stockholders.
 
(8) INCOME TAXES
 
     The statutory Federal tax rates for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994
and 1993 were 35%. The effective tax rates were zero for the years ended
December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993 due to the Company incurring net operating
losses for which no tax benefit was recorded.
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>   82
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(8) INCOME TAXES -- (CONTINUED)
     For Federal income tax purposes, the Company has unused net operating loss
carryforwards of approximately $37,804,000 expiring in 2007 through 2010. The
availability of the net operating loss carryforwards to offset income in future
years may be restricted if the Company undergoes an ownership change, which may
occur as a result of future sales of Company stock and other events.
 
     The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to significant
portions of the deferred tax assets are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    DECEMBER 31,
                                                            ----------------------------
                                                                1995            1994
                                                            ------------     -----------
     <S>                                                    <C>              <C>
     Accounts receivable principally due to allowance for
       doubtful accounts..................................  $    166,000     $   356,000
     OID Interest not deductible in current period........     2,933,000              --
     Net operating loss carryforwards.....................    13,231,000       6,271,000
                                                            ------------     -----------
               Total gross deferred tax assets............    16,330,000       6,627,000
     Less valuation allowance.............................   (16,330,000)     (6,627,000)
                                                            ------------     -----------
               Net deferred tax assets....................  $         --     $        --
                                                            ============     ===========
</TABLE>
 
     In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, management considers
whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax
assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is
dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in
which those temporary differences become deductible. Management considers the
scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income,
and tax planning in making these assessments. During 1995, 1994 and 1993, the
valuation allowance increased by $9,703,000, $4,267,000 and $1,978,000,
respectively.
 
(9) SEGMENT DATA
 
     The information below summarizes export sales by geographic area.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1995            1994            1993
                                             -----------     -----------     -----------
     <S>                                     <C>             <C>             <C>
     Latin America.........................  $12,093,771     $12,914,289     $12,492,542
     Europe................................           --       7,720,166       5,589,202
     Africa................................    1,207,225       1,832,547       1,761,965
     Asia/Pacific Rim......................    4,375,412       2,061,246         652,532
     Middle East...........................      554,139       1,449,093         559,387
     Other.................................      369,425         290,400         337,339
                                             -----------     -----------     -----------
                                             $18,599,972     $26,267,741     $21,392,967
                                             ===========     ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
     In late 1994, the European Network became operational and the Company began
to establish direct sales organizations within Europe. For the year ended
December 31, 1995, revenue, operating loss, capital expenditures and
depreciation expense from this geographic segment were approximately
$11,601,000, $11,076,000, $9,959,000 and $243,000, respectively. Identifiable
assets as of December 31, 1995 for this geographic segment were approximately
$10,216,000. For December 31, 1994 and for the year then ended, revenue, results
from operations, capital expenditures, depreciation expense and identifiable
assets for this geographic segment were not significant.
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>   83
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(10) STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN
 
     During 1993, the Board of Directors approved the 1993 Flexible Stock
Incentive Plan (the "Stock Incentive Plan") under which "non-qualified" stock
options ("NQSOs") to acquire shares of Common Stock may be granted to employees,
directors and consultants of the Company and "incentive" stock options ("ISOs")
to acquire shares of Common Stock may be granted to employees and directors. The
Stock Incentive Plan also provides for the grant of stock appreciation rights
("SARs") and shares of restricted stock to the Company's employees and directors
and consultants.
 
     The Stock Incentive Plan provides for the issuance of up to a maximum of
1,750,000 shares of Common Stock and is currently administered by the
Compensation Committee. Under the Stock Incentive Plan, the option price of any
ISO may not be less than the fair market value of a share of Common Stock on the
date on which the option is granted. The option price of an NQSO may be less
than the fair market value on the date the NQSO is granted if the Compensation
Committee so determines. An ISO may not be granted to a "ten percent
stockholder" (as such term is defined in Section 422A of the Internal Revenue
Code) unless the exercise price is at least 110% of the fair market value of the
Common Stock and the term of the option may not exceed five years from the date
of grant. Common Stock subject to a restricted stock purchase or bonus agreement
is transferable only as provided in such agreement. The maximum term of each
stock option granted to persons other than ten percent stockholders is ten years
from the date of grant.
 
     As of December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, options to purchase 745,123,
596,514 and 121,014 shares of Common Stock were outstanding respectively, at
exercise prices ranging from $.50 to $3.90 per share. As of December 31, 1995,
no SARs have been granted.
 
     Stock option activity under the Stock Incentive Plan is shown below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           OPTION PRICE
                                                                      -----------------------
                                                         NUMBER OF    PER SHARE      TOTAL
                                                          SHARES       AVERAGE       PRICE
                                                         ---------    ---------    ----------
     <S>                                                 <C>          <C>          <C>
     Shares under option at January 1, 1993
     Granted..........................................     121,014      $0.50      $   60,507
                                                          --------      -----      ----------
     Shares under option at December 31, 1993.........     121,014      $0.50      $   60,507
     Granted..........................................     475,500      $2.49      $1,183,995
                                                          --------      -----      ----------
     Shares under option at December 31, 1994.........     596,514      $2.09      $1,244,502
     Granted..........................................     291,500      $3.90      $1,136,850
     Forfeitures......................................    (142,891)     $2.65      $ (378,809)
                                                          --------      -----      ----------
     Shares under option at December 31, 1995.........     745,123      $2.69      $2,002,543
                                                          ========      =====      ==========
</TABLE>
 
     As of December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, options exercisable under the Stock
Incentive Plan were 461,553, 377,482 and 60,507, respectively.
 
     Prior to the adoption of the Stock Incentive Plan, 8,871 options were
granted. As of December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, these options were outstanding
and fully vested, subject to early termination under certain conditions and are
exercisable at $.50 per share through December 31, 2002.
 
     The exercise price of all options was equal to the fair market value of the
Common Stock at the date of grant.
 
     In addition, prior to the adoption of the Stock Incentive Plan, the Board
of Directors authorized the issuance of up to 350,000 shares of Common Stock as
compensation to employees and consultants of
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>   84
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(10) STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN -- (CONTINUED)
the Company. Pursuant to this authorization, the Company issued 20,542 shares in
1993 in partial payment of a finders fee in connection with a purchase of Common
Stock by a principal stockholder of the Company.
 
(11) COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
  (a) Leases
 
     At December 31, 1995, the Company was committed under non-cancelable
operating leases for the rental of office space and data processing equipment.
 
     The Company's future minimum operating lease payments are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
                 <S>                                                <C>
                 1996............................................   $1,062,388
                 1997............................................      962,466
                 1998............................................      909,238
                 1999............................................      768,818
                 2000............................................      688,376
                 Thereafter......................................      742,195
                                                                    ----------
                                                                    $5,133,481
                                                                    ==========
</TABLE>
 
     Total rent expense amounted to $948,826, $935,267 and $420,713 for the
years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
 
     On August 4, 1995, the Company entered into a termination agreement with a
vendor, pursuant to which the Company prepaid the 8% existing capital lease
obligation of approximately $1,025,000, thereby acquiring all of the equipment
previously leased.
 
  (b) Carrier Contracts
 
     The Company has entered into contracts to purchase transmission capacity
from various domestic and foreign carriers. By committing to purchase minimum
volumes of transmission capacity from carriers, the Company is able to obtain
guaranteed rates which are more favorable than those generally offered in the
marketplace. The minimum purchase commitments are $8,300,000 for the year ending
December 31, 1996.
 
  (c) Purchase Commitments
 
     The Company is continually upgrading and expanding the European Network and
the Omaha, Nebraska switching facility. In connection therewith, the Company has
entered into purchase commitments to expend approximately $1,200,000. The
Company has also entered into purchase commitments of approximately $400,000 in
connection with financial and administrative software upgrades.
 
  (d) Employment Contracts
 
     The Company has employment contracts with certain officers at amounts
generally equal to such officers' current levels of compensation. The Company's
remaining commitments at December 31, 1995 for the next three years under such
contracts aggregates approximately $916,000.
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>   85
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                        DECEMBER 31, 1995, 1994 AND 1993
 
(11) COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES -- (CONTINUED)
  (e) Litigation
 
     As a result of the Company's transition to direct sales organizations in
Europe, two of its former independent sales representatives, in France and in
Spain, have asserted breach of contract and certain other claims. Arbitration
proceedings in respect to these claims are currently under way or pending. The
aggregate amount of damages sought by the representatives is $8.8 million. The
Company believes that it has meritorious defenses against the claims alleged by
the representatives and intends to vigorously pursue all such defenses but the
outcomes can not be predicted. The Company believes that any possible awards in
these suits would not be in excess of $1 million in the aggregate and would
result in an increase in recorded cost of the territorial exclusivity rights.
 
(12) REGULATORY MATTERS
 
     The Company is subject to regulation in countries in which it does
business. The Company believes that an adverse determination as to the
permissibility of the Company's services under the laws and regulations of any
such country would not have a material adverse long-term effect on its business.
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>   86
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                MARCH 31,
                                                                                   1996
                                                                               ------------
                                                                               (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                            <C>
ASSETS
Current assets:
  Cash and cash equivalents................................................    $  1,905,401
  Marketable securities, current...........................................      21,176,310
  Trade accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of
     $549,000..............................................................       5,462,506
  Other receivables........................................................       2,942,537
  Prepaid expenses.........................................................         989,478
                                                                                -----------
          Total current assets.............................................      32,476,232
                                                                                -----------
Marketable securities, non-current.........................................              --
Property and equipment, less accumulated depreciation and amortization of
  $3,654,366...............................................................      17,589,704
Deferred financing and registration fees, less accumulated amortization of
  $458,000.................................................................       3,336,664
Intangible assets, net.....................................................       2,452,777
Other assets...............................................................       1,628,049
                                                                                -----------
                                                                               $ 57,483,426
                                                                                ===========
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT
Current liabilities:
  Accrued telecommunications costs.........................................    $  8,378,114
  Accounts payable and other accrued expenses..............................       5,629,808
  Commissions payable......................................................         322,593
                                                                                -----------
          Total current liabilities........................................      14,330,515
                                                                                -----------
Long-term liabilities:
  Senior discount notes, less discount of $50,908,745......................      69,791,255
Commitments and contingencies
Stockholders' deficit:
  Common Stock, $.01 par value. Authorized 50,000,000 shares, issued and
     outstanding 16,104,202 shares.........................................         161,042
  Class A Common Stock, $.01 par value. Authorized 10,000,000 shares,
     issued and outstanding, 4,357,270.....................................          43,573
  Additional paid-in capital...............................................      30,030,805
  Unearned compensation....................................................         (68,250)
  Cumulative translation adjustment........................................         (67,866)
  Accumulated deficit......................................................     (56,737,648)
                                                                                -----------
          Total stockholders' deficit......................................     (26,638,344)
                                                                                -----------
                                                                               $ 57,483,426
                                                                                ===========
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>   87
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                   THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 AND 1995
                                  (UNAUDITED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FOR THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                          MARCH 31,
                                                                ------------------------------
                                                                    1996              1995
                                                                ------------      ------------
<S>                                                             <C>               <C>
Telecommunications revenue....................................  $ 10,590,270      $  6,929,299
                                                                 -----------       -----------
Operating expenses:
  Costs of telecommunications services........................     8,999,249         5,900,232
  Selling expenses............................................     2,401,224         1,536,697
  General and administrative expense..........................     5,129,090         2,902,549
  Depreciation and amortization...............................     1,087,677           499,278
                                                                 -----------       -----------
          Total operating expenses............................    17,617,240        10,838,756
                                                                 -----------       -----------
Other income (expenses):
  Interest income.............................................       470,644         1,033,728
  Interest expense............................................    (2,569,196)       (2,087,018)
  Share in loss of affiliate..................................        (1,302)          (11,680)
                                                                 -----------       -----------
          Net loss............................................  $ (9,126,824)     $ (4,974,427)
                                                                 ===========       ===========
          Net loss per common share...........................  $      (0.45)     $      (0.24)
                                                                 ===========       ===========
          Weighted average common shares outstanding..........    20,461,472        20,461,472
                                                                 ===========       ===========
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>   88
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                   THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 AND 1995
                                  (UNAUDITED)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                         MARCH 31,
                                                                ----------------------------
                                                                   1996             1995
                                                                -----------     ------------
<S>                                                             <C>             <C>
Cash flows from operating activities:
  Net loss....................................................  $(9,126,824)    $ (4,974,427)
  Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in
     operating activities:
     Depreciation and amortization............................    1,087,677          499,278
     Interest expense on senior discount notes................    2,568,623        2,046,919
     Accrued interest income on marketable securities.........      (64,734)        (564,178)
     Provision for losses on accounts receivable..............      373,037           77,789
     Share in loss of affiliate...............................        1,302           11,680
     Unearned compensation....................................        9,750               --
  Changes in assets and liabilities:
     Increase in accounts receivable..........................   (1,098,590)        (409,914)
     Increase in prepaid expenses and other receivables.......     (223,734)        (498,660)
     Increase in other assets.................................     (144,032)        (285,208)
     Decrease in accrued telecommunications costs, accounts
       payable, other accrued expenses and commissions
       payable................................................   (1,564,796)      (1,912,977)
                                                                -----------     ------------
          Net cash used in operating activities...............   (8,182,321)      (6,009,698)
                                                                -----------     ------------
Cash flows from investing activities:
  Purchase of property, equipment and software................   (3,227,251)      (3,134,453)
  Issuance of notes receivable................................     (323,227)              --
  Investment in marketable securities.........................   (5,276,748)     (50,695,308)
  Proceeds from maturity of marketable securities.............   10,086,464               --
  Investment in affiliate.....................................      (87,412)          (5,176)
                                                                -----------     ------------
          Net cash provided by (used in) investment
            activities........................................    1,171,826      (53,834,937)
                                                                -----------     ------------
Cash flows from financing activities:
  Payments under capital leases...............................           --         (170,011)
  Repayment of notes payable..................................           --       (1,316,755)
                                                                -----------     ------------
          Net cash used in financing activities...............           --       (1,486,766)
                                                                -----------     ------------
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash......................      (19,018)          34,610
                                                                -----------     ------------
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents.....................   (7,029,513)     (61,296,791)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period..............    8,934,914       66,761,614
                                                                -----------     ------------
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period....................  $ 1,905,401     $  5,464,823
                                                                ===========     ============
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
  Interest paid...............................................  $        --     $     40,099
                                                                ===========     ============
</TABLE>
 
          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>   89
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
             (INFORMATION AS OF MARCH 31, 1996 AND FOR THE PERIODS
                  ENDING MARCH 31, 1996 AND 1995 IS UNAUDITED)
 
(1)  INTERIM CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
     The consolidated financial statements as of March 31, 1996 and for the
three month periods ended March 31, 1996 and 1995 have been prepared by Viatel,
Inc. and subsidiaries (collectively, the "Company"), without audit, pursuant to
the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. In the
opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting of only normal recurring
accruals) necessary for a fair presentation of the consolidated results of
financial position, operations and cash flows for each period presented have
been made on a consistent basis. Certain information and footnote disclosures
normally included in consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles have been condensed or omitted
pursuant to such rules and regulations although management believes that the
disclosures herein are adequate to make information presented not misleading. It
is suggested that these financial statements should be read in conjunction with
the Company's 1995 annual consolidated financial statements. Operating results
for the three months ended March 31, 1996 may not necessarily be indicative of
the results that may be expected for the full year.
 
     The Company has adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No. 121
"Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to
be disposed of" ("SFAS 121") and Statement of Financial Accounting Standard No.
123 "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" ("SFAS 123") as of January 1,
1996. With respect to SFAS 123, the Company elected the "intrinsic value" based
method of accounting for its stock-based compensation arrangements. The adoption
of SFAS 121 or SFAS 123 did not have a material adverse effect on the Company.
 
(2)  INVESTMENTS IN DEBT SECURITIES
 
     Management determines the appropriate classification of its investments in
debt securities at the time of purchase and reevaluates such determination at
each balance sheet date. These investments are diversified among high credit
quality securities in accordance with the Company's investment policy. Debt
securities that the Company has both the intent and ability to hold to maturity
are carried at amortized cost. Debt securities for which the Company does not
have the intent or ability to hold to maturity are classified as available for
sale. Securities available for sale are carried at fair value, with the
unrealized gains and losses, net of tax, reported in a separate component of
stockholders' equity. At March 31, 1996, the Company had no investments that
qualified as trading.
 
     The amortized cost of debt securities classified as held to maturity and
available for sale are adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of
discounts to maturity over the estimated life of the security. Such amortization
and interest are included in interest income.
 
     The following is a summary of the fair value of securities held to maturity
and securities available for sale at March 31, 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               SECURITIES     SECURITIES
                                                HELD TO        AVAILABLE
                                                MATURITY       FOR SALE          TOTAL
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
    <S>                                        <C>            <C>             <C>
    Money market instruments.................  $1,166,127     $        --     $ 1,166,127
    Federal agencies obligations.............          --       1,109,518       1,109,518
    Corporate debt securities................          --      18,900,665      18,900,665
                                               ----------     -----------     -----------
              Total..........................  $1,166,127     $20,010,183     $21,176,310
                                               ==========     ===========     ===========
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-20
<PAGE>   90
 
                         VIATEL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
             (INFORMATION AS OF MARCH 31, 1996 AND FOR THE PERIODS
                  ENDING MARCH 31, 1996 AND 1995 IS UNAUDITED)
 
(2)  INVESTMENTS IN DEBT SECURITIES -- (CONTINUED)
     The fair value of each investment approximates the amortized cost and,
therefore, there are no unrealized gains or losses as of March 31, 1996.
 
     Based upon contractual maturity, all securities held to maturity and
securities available for sale at March 31, 1996 are due within one year.
 
     Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because
borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call
or prepayment penalties.
 
     There were no changes in the classification of any securities held to
maturity or securities available for sale from the time of purchase to the time
of maturity or sale.
 
(3)  REGULATORY MATTERS
 
     The Company is subject to regulation in countries in which it does
business. The Company believes that an adverse determination as to the
permissibility of the Company's services under the laws and regulations of any
such country would not have a material adverse long-term effect on its business.
 
(4)  COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES -- LITIGATION
 
     As a result of the Company's transition to direct sales organizations in
Europe, one of its former independent sales representatives, in Spain, has
asserted breach of contract claims. Arbitration proceedings in respect to this
claim are currently under way or pending. The aggregate amount of damages sought
by the representative is $5.8 million. The Company believes that it has
meritorious defenses against the claims alleged by the representative and
intends to vigorously pursue all such defenses but the outcome cannot be
predicted.
 
(5)  SUBSEQUENT EVENT
 
     On June 5, 1996, a French arbitration tribunal rendered a judgment against
the Company in connection with a claim by an independent sales representative
(the "Claimant") for alleged breach of contract and certain other claims. The
Claimant requested total monetary damages of approximately $3 million and sought
reinstatement as the Company's exclusive sales representative in France.
Although the arbitration panel awarded the Claimant $0.86 million (based on
foreign currency exchange rates in effect as of July 31, 1996), the panel
terminated the Claimant's sales agency, resulting in an increase in the recorded
cost of intangible assets related to territorial exclusivity rights and will be
amortized over twenty one months which corresponds to the remaining period of
territorial exclusivity previously granted to this independent sales
representative.
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>   91
 
NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS AND, IF GIVEN OR
MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN
AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY OR BY ANY OF THE UNDERWRITERS. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF
THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES,
CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE
COMPANY SINCE THE DATES AS OF WHICH INFORMATION IS GIVEN IN THIS PROSPECTUS.
THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER OR SOLICITATION BY ANYONE IN ANY
JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH
THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANY
PERSON TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH SOLICITATION.
 
                       ---------------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           PAGE
                                           ----
<S>                                        <C>
Prospectus Summary......................     3
Risk Factors............................     7
Use of Proceeds.........................    18
Dividend Policy.........................    18
Dilution................................    19
Capitalization..........................    20
Selected Consolidated Financial and
  Other Data............................    21
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
  Financial Condition and Results of
  Operations............................    22
Business................................    29
Management..............................    44
Certain Transactions....................    52
Principal Stockholders..................    54
Description of Capital Stock............    56
Shares Eligible for Future Sale.........    60
Underwriting............................    62
Legal Matters...........................    64
Experts.................................    64
Additional Information..................    64
Glossary................................   G-1
Index to Consolidated Financial
  Statements............................   F-1
</TABLE>
 
                  SHARES
 
VIATEL, INC.
 
COMMON STOCK
($.01 PAR VALUE)
 
LOGO
- ------------------------------------------------------
 
SALOMON BROTHERS INC
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
 
PROSPECTUS
 
DATED                , 1996
<PAGE>   92
 
     INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
     REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
     MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
     BECOMES EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
     THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
     SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE
     UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS
     OF ANY SUCH STATE.
 
              [ALTERNATE FRONT COVER PAGE - INTERNATIONAL TRANCHE]
 
                             Subject to Completion
 
                                 August 7, 1996
PROSPECTUS
 
                                    SHARES
                                                                            LOGO
VIATEL, INC.
 
COMMON STOCK
($.01 PAR VALUE)
 
All of the shares of common stock (the "Common Stock") offered hereby are being
sold by Viatel, Inc. (the "Company" or "Viatel"). Of the             shares of
Common Stock offered,             shares are being offered by the U.S.
Underwriters (as defined herein) in the United States and Canada (the "U.S.
Offering") and             shares are being offered by the International
Underwriters (as defined herein), in a concurrent offering outside the United
States and Canada (the "International Offering" and together with the U.S.
Offering, the "Offerings"), subject to transfers between the U.S. Underwriters
and the International Underwriters (collectively, the "Underwriters"). The
initial public offering price and the aggregate underwriting discount per share
will be identical for the Offerings. See "Underwriting." The closing of the U.S.
Offering and the International Offering are conditioned upon each other.
 
Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common Stock. It
is currently estimated that the initial public offering price per share will be
between $            and $            . See "Underwriting" for a discussion of
the factors considered in determining the initial public offering price.
 
Application has been made to have the shares of Common Stock approved for
quotation on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "VYTL."
 
SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 7 FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS THAT
SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE POTENTIAL INVESTORS.
 
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A
CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  PRICE TO        UNDERWRITING     PROCEEDS TO
                                                   PUBLIC           DISCOUNT       COMPANY(1)
<S>                                            <C>               <C>               <C>
Per Share....................................  $                 $                 $
Total(2).....................................  $                 $                 $
</TABLE>
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) Before deducting offering expenses payable by the Company, estimated at
    $          .
(2) The Company has granted the Underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to
    an aggregate of       additional shares of Common Stock at the Price to
    Public, less the Underwriting Discount, solely to cover over-allotments, if
    any. If the Underwriters exercise such option in full, the total Price to
    Public, Underwriting Discount and Proceeds to Company will be $          ,
    $          and $          , respectively. See "Underwriting."
 
The shares of Common Stock are offered subject to receipt and acceptance by the
Underwriters, to prior sale and to the Underwriters' right to reject any order
in whole or in part and to withdraw, cancel or modify the offer without notice.
It is expected that delivery of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby will
be made at the office of Salomon Brothers Inc, Seven World Trade Center, New
York, New York, or through the facilities of The Depository Trust Company, on or
about                     , 1996.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SALOMON BROTHERS INTERNATIONAL LIMITED
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The date of this Prospectus is                     , 1996.
<PAGE>   93
 
           [ALTERNATE UNDERWRITING SECTION -- INTERNATIONAL TRANCHE]
 
                                  UNDERWRITING
 
     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in an underwriting agreement
among the Company and the International Underwriters (the "International
Underwriting Agreement"), the Company has agreed to sell to each of the
International Underwriters named below (the "International Underwriters"), and
each of the International Underwriters, for whom Salomon Brothers International
Limited is acting as the international representative (the "International
Representative"), has severally agreed to purchase the number of shares of
Common Stock set forth opposite its name below.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        NUMBER OF
                           INTERNATIONAL UNDERWRITERS                    SHARES
            --------------------------------------------------------    ---------
            <S>                                                         <C>
            Salomon Brothers International Limited..................
 
                                                                            ----
                      Total.........................................
                                                                            ====
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has been advised by the International Representative that the
several International Underwriters initially propose to offer such shares of
Common Stock to the public at the public offering price set forth on the cover
page of this Prospectus and to certain dealers at such price less a concession
not in excess of $          per share of Common Stock. The International
Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may re-allow, a concession not in
excess of $          per share of Common Stock to other dealers. After the
Offerings, the public offering price and such concessions may be changed.
 
     The Company has granted to the International Underwriters and the U.S.
underwriters (the "U.S. Underwriters" and, collectively with the International
Underwriters, the "Underwriters") an option, exercisable during the 30-day
period after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to           additional
shares of Common Stock from the Company at the price to public less the
underwriting discount, solely to cover over-allotments. To the extent that the
International Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters exercise such option, each
of the International Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters, as the case may be,
will be committed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase a number of option
shares proportionate to such International Underwriter's or U.S. Underwriter's
initial commitment.
 
     The Company has entered into a U.S. Underwriting Agreement with the U.S.
Underwriters named therein, for whom Salomon Brothers Inc, is acting as the
representative (the "U.S. Representative"), providing for the concurrent offer
and sale of           shares of Common Stock (in addition to the shares covered
by the over-allotment option described above) in the United States and Canada.
Both the International Underwriting Agreement and the U.S. Underwriting
Agreement provide that the obligations of the International Underwriters and the
U.S. Underwriters are such that if any of the shares of Common Stock are
purchased by the International Underwriters pursuant to the International
Underwriting Agreement, or by the U.S. Underwriters pursuant to the U.S.
Underwriting Agreement, all the shares of Common Stock agreed to be purchased by
either the International Underwriters or the U.S. Underwriters, as the case may
be, pursuant to their respective agreements must be so purchased. The price to
public and underwriting discount per share of Common Stock for the International
Offering and the U.S. Offering will be identical. The closing of the U.S.
Offering is a condition to the closing of the International Offering and the
closing of the International Offering is a condition to the closing of the U.S.
Offering.
 
     Each International Underwriter has severally agreed that, as part of the
distribution of the           shares of Common Stock offered by the
International Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing any shares of Common Stock
for the account of any United States or Canadian Person and (ii) it has not
offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, any shares
of Common Stock or distribute this
 
                                       62
<PAGE>   94
 
Prospectus to any person within the United States or Canada or to any United
States or Canadian Person. Each U.S. Underwriter has severally agreed that, as
part of the distribution of the             shares of Common Stock by the U.S.
Underwriters, (i) it is not purchasing any shares of Common Stock for the
account of anyone other than a United States or Canadian Person, and (ii) it has
not offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, any
shares of Common Stock or distribute any Prospectus relating to the U.S.
Offering to any person outside the United States or Canada or to anyone other
than a United States or Canadian person.
 
     The foregoing limitations do not apply to stabilization transactions or to
certain other transactions specified in the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters
and International Underwriters. "United States" or "Canadian Person" means any
person who is a national or resident of the United States or Canada, any
corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or Canada or of any political subdivision thereof, and
any estate or trust which is subject to United States or Canadian federal income
taxation, regardless of the source of its income (other than the foreign branch
of any United States or Canadian Person), and includes any United States or
Canadian branch of a person other than a United States or Canadian Person.
 
     Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. Underwriters and International
Underwriters, sales may be made between the International Underwriters and the
U.S. Underwriters of such number of shares of Common Stock as may be mutually
agreed. The price of any shares of Common Stock so sold shall be the public
offering price, less an amount not greater than the concession to securities
dealers. To the extent that there are sales between the International
Underwriters and the U.S. Underwriters pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S.
Underwriters and International Underwriters, the number of shares of Common
Stock initially available for sale by the International Underwriters or by the
U.S. Underwriters may be more or less than the amount specified on the cover
page of this Prospectus.
 
     Each International Underwriter has severally represented and agreed that:
(i) it has not offered or sold and, prior to the date six months after the
closing date of the Offerings, will not offer to sell any shares of Common Stock
to persons in the United Kingdom except to persons whose ordinary activities
involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of investments (as
principal or agent) for the purposes of their businesses or otherwise in
circumstances which have not resulted and will not result in an offer to the
public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of the Public Offers of
Securities Regulations 1995 (the "Regulations"); (ii) it has complied and will
comply with all applicable provisions of the Financial Services Act 1986 and the
Regulations with respect to anything done by it in relation to the shares of
Common Stock in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom; and (iii) it
has only issued or passed on or will only issue or pass on in the United Kingdom
any document received by it in connection with the issue of the shares of Common
Stock, to a person who is of a kind described in Article 11(3) of the Financial
Services Act 1986 (Investment Advertisements) (Exemptions) Order 1995, or is a
person to whom the document may otherwise lawfully be issued or passed on.
 
     Purchasers of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby may be required to
pay stamp taxes and other charges in accordance with the laws and practices of
the country of purchase in addition to the offering price set forth on the cover
page thereof.
 
     The International Underwriting Agreement provides that the Company will
indemnify the International Underwriters against certain liabilities and
expenses, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or contribute to
payments the International Underwriters may be required to make in respect
thereof.
 
     The Company and each of its directors and executive officers and certain
other stockholders have agreed not to offer, sell, contract to sell or otherwise
dispose of, directly or indirectly, or announce the offering of any shares of
Common Stock, including any such shares beneficially or indirectly owned or
controlled by the Company, or any securities convertible into, or exchangeable
or exercisable for, shares of Common Stock, for   days from the date of this
Prospectus, without the prior written consent of Salomon Brothers Inc except for
(i) shares issued in connection with any employee benefit or incentive plans of
the Company existing on the date of this Prospectus, (ii) shares issued in
respect of obligations existing before the date of this Prospectus and (iii)
shares issued in connection with the Offerings.
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   95
 
     The International Representative does not intend to confirm sales to any
account over which it exercises discretionary authority.
 
     Prior to the Offerings, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock. The initial public offering price of the Common Stock will be determined
by negotiation among the Company, the International Representative and the U.S.
Representative. The factors to be considered in determining the initial public
offering price include the information set forth in this Prospectus and
otherwise available to the International Representative and the U.S.
Representative, the history of and future prospects for the industry in which
the Company competes, the ability of the Company's management, the general
conditions of the securities market at the time of the Offerings and the market
prices of securities and certain financial and operating information of
companies engaged in activities similar to those of the Company. There can be no
assurance that the price at which shares of Common Stock will sell in the public
market after the Offerings will not be lower than the price at which they are
sold in the Offerings by the Underwriters.
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   96
 
                     [TAX SECTION -- INTERNATIONAL TRANCHE]
 
     CERTAIN UNITED STATES TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR NON-UNITED STATES HOLDERS
 
     The following is a discussion of certain United States federal income and
estate tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of shares
applicable to Non-United States Holders of Common Stock. In general, a "Non-U.S.
Holder" is any person other than (i) a citizen or resident of the United States,
(ii) a corporation created or organized in the United States or under the laws
of the United States or of any State or (iii) an estate or trust whose income is
includable in gross income for United States federal income tax purposes
regardless of its source. The discussion is based on current law and is for
general information only. The discussion assumes that the Common Stock will be
included in the Nasdaq National Market. The discussion does not address aspects
of taxation other than federal income and estate taxation and does not address
all aspects of federal income and estate taxation. The discussion does not
consider any specific facts or circumstances that may apply to a particular
Non-U.S. Holder. The discussion assumes that a Non-U.S. Holder holds its Common
Stock as a "capital asset" (generally, non-depreciable property held for
investment) for federal income tax purposes. Moreover, the discussion does not
address legislation which is currently being considered by Congress or has been
proposed by the Treasury Department that could adversely effect a Non-U.S.
Holder. Accordingly, prospective investors are urged to consult their tax
advisors regarding the United States federal, state, local, non-United States
income and other tax consequences of acquiring, holding and disposing of shares
of Common Stock, and whether such a prospective investor would be treated as a
resident of the United States for federal income tax purposes.
 
     Dividends.  In general, dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder that are not
effectively connected with a trade or business carried on by the Non-U.S. Holder
within the United States will be subject to United States withholding tax at a
rate of 30% of the gross amount thereof. Dividends effectively connected with a
United States trade or business of a Non-U.S. Holder generally will not be
subject to withholding (if the Non-U.S. Holder files certain forms with the
payor of the dividend) and generally will be subject to United States federal
income tax at the same rates and in the same manner as if the income had been
received by a domestic taxpayer. In the case of Non-U.S. Holder corporations,
such effectively connected income also may be subject to the branch profits tax
(which generally is imposed on a foreign corporation in connection with earnings
and profits effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business). Non-U.S.
Holders should consult any applicable income tax treaties, which may provide for
reduced withholding or other rules different from those described above. A
Non-U.S. Holder may be required to satisfy certain certification requirements in
order to claim treaty benefits or to otherwise claim a reduction of or exemption
from withholding under the foregoing rules.
 
     Sale of Common Stock.  Generally, a Non-U.S. Holder will not be subject to
United States federal income tax on any gain realized upon the disposition of
his Common Stock unless (i) the Company is or has been during the five-year
period ending on the date of disposition, a "United States real property holding
corporation" for federal income tax purposes (which the Company has not been, is
not and is not likely to become) and the Non-U.S. Holder held, directly or
indirectly at anytime during the five-year period ending on the date of
disposition, more than 5% of the Common Stock, (ii) the gain is effectively
connected with a trade or business carried on by the Non-U.S. Holder within the
United States or, if a tax treaty applies, is attributable to a permanent
establishment (generally an office or other fixed place of business maintained
by the Non-U.S. Holder in the United States), or (iii) the Non-U.S. Holder is an
individual who holds the Common Stock as a capital asset and is present in the
United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the disposition and
either (a) such Non-U.S. Holder individual has a "tax home" (as defined for
United States federal income tax purposes) in the United States and either the
gain from the disposition is not attributable to an office or other fixed place
of business maintained by the Non-U.S. Holder individual in a foreign country
or, if it is, an income tax equal to at least 10% of the gain is not actually
paid to a foreign country or (b) the gain from the disposition is attributable
to an office or other fixed place of business maintained in the United States by
such Non-U.S. Holder individual. Gain that is effectively connected with the
conduct of a trade or business within the United States by a Non-
 
                                       65
<PAGE>   97
 
U.S. Holder will be subject to United States federal income tax on net income
that applies to United States persons (and, with respect to corporate holders
under certain circumstances, the branch profits tax), but will not be subject to
withholding. An individual described in (iii) above generally will be subject to
tax at a 30% rate on any gain recognized on such disposition, but will not be
subject to withholding. Individual Non-U.S. Holders also may be subject to tax
pursuant to provisions of United States federal income tax law applicable to
expatriates of the United States. Non-U.S. Holders should consult applicable
treaties, which may provide for different rules.
 
     Estate Tax.  Common Stock owned or treated as owned by an individual who is
not a citizen or resident (as defined for United States federal estate tax
purposes) of the United States at the time of death will be includable in the
individual's gross estate for United States federal estate tax purposes, unless
an applicable tax treaty provides otherwise. Such individual's estate may be
subject to United States federal estate tax on the property includable in the
estate for United States federal estate tax purposes. Estates of nonresident
aliens are generally allowed a $13,000 credit against the estate tax otherwise
due; however, applicable tax treaties may provide for an increased estate tax
credit.
 
     Backup Withholding and Information Reporting.  The Company must report
annually to the Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS") and to each Non-U.S. Holder
the amount of dividends paid to, and the tax withheld with respect to, each
Non-U.S. Holder. These information reporting requirements apply regardless of
whether withholding was reduced or eliminated by an applicable tax treaty or
eliminated because such dividends were effectively connected with a United
States trade or business and the Non-U.S. Holder files certain forms with the
payor. Copies of these information returns also may be made available under the
provisions of a specific treaty or agreement to the tax authorities in the
country in which the Non-U.S. Holder resides. United States backup withholding
tax (which generally is a withholding tax imposed at the rate of 31% on certain
payments to United States persons that fail to furnish the information required
under the United States information reporting requirements) generally will not
apply to dividends paid on Common Stock to a Non-U.S. Holder if the dividends
are subject to withholding at the 30% rate (or lower treaty rate) or would be
subject to withholding at the 30% rate (or lower treaty rate) but for the fact
that such dividends are effectively connected with a United States trade or
business.
 
     The payment of the proceeds from the disposition of Common Stock to or
through the United States office of a broker will be subject to information
reporting and backup withholding unless the owner, under penalties of perjury,
certifies, among other things, as to its status as a Non-U.S. Holder or
otherwise establishes an exemption (and the broker has no actual knowledge to
the contrary). The payment of the proceeds from the disposition of Common Stock
to or through a non-United States office of a broker generally will not be
subject to information reporting or backup withholding. However, information
reporting (but not backup withholding) will apply to a payment of the proceeds
from a sale of Common Stock if the payment is made through a non-United States
office of a United States broker or through a non-United States office of a
non-United States broker that is (i) a "controlled foreign corporation" (as
defined for United States federal income tax purposes) as to the United States
or (ii) a person 50% or more of whose gross income for a certain three-year
period is effectively connected with a United States trade or business, unless
the broker has documentary evidence in its records that the holder is a Non-U.S.
Holder and the broker does not have actual knowledge to the contrary and certain
conditions are met, or the holder otherwise establishes an exemption.
 
     Backup withholding tax is not an additional tax and may be credited against
a holder's United States federal income tax liability, provided that required
information is furnished to the IRS. Non-U.S. Holders generally may obtain a
refund of any excess amount withheld under the backup withholding rules by
filing the appropriate refund claim with the IRS.
 
     The Treasury Department has issued proposed regulations that would modify
the information reporting and withholding rules as they apply to Non-U.S.
Holders. The proposed regulations would unify the current certification
procedures and forms and would, in certain circumstances, require additional
information from Non-U.S. Holders claiming treaty benefits. The proposed
regulations are scheduled to take effect January 1, 1998, and are subject to
further changes. Consequently, the proposed regulations are not discussed in
this section.
 
                                       66
<PAGE>   98
 
              [ALTERNATE BACK COVER PAGE - INTERNATIONAL TRANCHE]
 
NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS AND, IF GIVEN OR
MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN
AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY OR, BY ANY OF THE UNDERWRITERS. NEITHER THE DELIVERY
OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES,
CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE
COMPANY SINCE THE DATES AS OF WHICH INFORMATION IS GIVEN IN THIS PROSPECTUS.
THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER OR SOLICITATION BY ANYONE IN ANY
JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH
THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANY
PERSON TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH SOLICITATION.
 
                       ---------------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           PAGE
                                           ----
<S>                                        <C>
Prospectus Summary......................     3
Risk Factors............................     7
Use of Proceeds.........................    18
Dividend Policy.........................    18
Dilution................................    19
Capitalization..........................    20
Selected Consolidated Financial and
  Other Data............................    21
Management's Discussion and Analysis of
  Financial Condition and Results of
  Operations............................    22
Business................................    29
Management..............................    44
Certain Transactions....................    52
Principal Stockholders..................    54
Description of Capital Stock............    56
Shares Eligible for Future Sale.........    60
Underwriting............................    62
Certain United States Tax Considerations
  for Non-United States Holders.........    65
Legal Matters...........................    67
Experts.................................    67
Additional Information..................    67
Glossary................................   G-1
Index to Consolidated Financial
  Statements............................   F-1
</TABLE>
 
                  SHARES
 
VIATEL, INC.
 
COMMON STOCK
($.01 PAR VALUE)
 
LOGO
- ---------------------------------------------------
 
SALOMON BROTHERS
INTERNATIONAL LIMITED
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------
 
PROSPECTUS
 
DATED                , 1996
<PAGE>   99
 
                                    PART II
 
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
ITEM 13.  OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION
 
     The following table sets forth the various expenses in connection with the
sale and distribution of the securities being registered, other than
underwriting discounts and commissions. All the amounts shown are estimated
except the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") registration
fee, the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD") filing
fee and the Nasdaq National Market listing fee.
 
<TABLE>
    <S>                                                                      <C>
    Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee...................   $ 46,553.00
    NASD filing fee.......................................................     14,000.00
    Nasdaq National Market listing application fee........................     50,000.00
    Printing and engraving expenses.......................................             *
    Legal fees and expenses...............................................             *
    Accounting fees and expenses..........................................             *
    Blue Sky fees and expenses (including legal fees).....................             *
    Transfer agent and registrar fees and expenses........................             *
    Miscellaneous.........................................................             *
                                                                                 -------
              Total.......................................................   $         *
                                                                                 =======
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
* To be supplied by amendment.
 
ITEM 14.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS
 
     Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the "DGCL") provides
that a Delaware corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is
threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action,
suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (a
"proceeding") (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) by
reason of the fact that he is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of
the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a
director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint
venture, trust or other enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys'
fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably
incurred by him in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if he acted
in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to
the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action
or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful. A
Delaware corporation may indemnify any person under such Section in connection
with a proceeding by or in the right of the corporation to procure judgment in
its favor, as provided in the preceding sentence, against expenses (including
attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with the
defense or settlement of such action, except that no indemnification shall be
made in respect thereof unless, and then only to the extent that, a court of
competent jurisdiction shall determine upon application that such person is
fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for such expenses as the court shall
deem proper. A Delaware corporation must indemnify any person who was successful
on the merits or otherwise in defense of any action, suit or proceeding or in
defense of any claim, issue or matter in any proceeding, by reason of the fact
that he is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation or
is or was serving at the request of the corporation, against expenses (including
attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection
therewith. A Delaware corporation may pay for the expenses (including attorneys'
fees) incurred by an officer or director in defending a proceeding in advance of
the final disposition upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such
officer or director to repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined
that he is not entitled to be indemnified by the corporation.
 
                                      II-1
<PAGE>   100
 
     Section 102(b)(7) of the DGCL permits a corporation to provide in its
certificate of incorporation that a director shall not be personally liable to
the corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for a breach of
fiduciary duty as a director, except for liability (i) for any breach of the
director's duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for any
acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a
knowing violation of law, (iii) in respect of certain unlawful dividend payments
or stock redemptions or repurchases, or (iv) for any transaction from which the
director derived an improper personal benefit. Article Ninth of the Company's
Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, eliminates the liability of directors
to the fullest extent permitted by Section 102(b)(7) of the DGCL. The DGCL
permits the purchase of insurance on behalf of directors and officers against
any liability asserted against directors and officers and incurred by such
persons in such capacity, or arising out of their status as such, whether or not
the corporation would have the power to indemnify directors and officers against
such liability. The Company has obtained officers' and directors' liability
insurance of $10 million for members of its Board of Directors and executive
officers. In addition, the Company has entered into agreements to indemnify its
directors and officers from and against any Expenses (as defined in the
indemnity agreement) incurred by such person in connection with investigating,
defending, serving as a witness in, participating in (including on appeal), or
preparing for any of the foregoing in any threatened, pending or contemplated
action, suit, or proceeding (including an action by or in the right of the
Company), or any inquiry, hearing or investigation, to the fullest extent
permitted by law, as such law may be amended or interpreted (but only to the
extent that such amendment or interpretation provides for broader
indemnification rights). The indemnity agreement contains certain provisions to
ensure that the indemnitee receives the benefits contemplated by the agreement
in the event of a "change in control" (as defined in the indemnity agreement)
such as the establishment and funding of a trust in an amount sufficient to
satisfy any and all expenses reasonably anticipated to be incurred by the
indemnitee in connection with investigating, preparing for, participating in
and/or defending a proceeding.
 
     At present, there is no pending litigation or other proceeding involving a
director or officer of the Company as to which indemnification is being sought,
nor is the Company aware of any threatened litigation that may result in claims
for indemnification by any officer or director.
 
     Reference is made to the form of U.S. Underwriting Agreement and
International Underwriting Agreement, filed as Exhibits 1.1 and 1.2 to this
Registration Statement which provide for indemnification of the directors and
officers signing this Registration Statement and certain controlling persons of
the Registrant against certain liabilities, including those arising under the
Securities Act, in certain instances by the Underwriters.
 
     Article Tenth of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Article X
of the Company's Bylaws provide for indemnification of directors and officers to
the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of the DGCL.
 
ITEM 15.  RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES
 
     The following sets forth information as to all securities issued by the
Registrant during the past three years which were not registered under the
Securities Act.
 
     In October 1993, the Company issued 69,445 shares of Common Stock to an
unaffiliated accredited investor. Such shares were issued in connection with a
purchase by such unaffiliated accredited investor of 333,333 1/3 shares of
Common Stock in February 1993. The aggregate consideration paid by such
unaffiliated accredited investor for the 402,778 1/3 shares of Common Stock was
$1,000,000. During October and December 1993, the Company sold to S-C V-Tel
Investments, L.P., a principal stockholder, 2,547,406 shares of Common Stock for
consideration in an aggregate amount of $5,000,000 and for, consideration in an
aggregate amount of $1,000, certain warrants to purchase additional shares of
Common Stock. No warrants were exercised prior to expiration on October 15,
1995. Also in October 1993, the Company issued 20,542 shares of Common Stock to
a former officer of the Company in payment of a finder's fee owed to such
officer in connection with the sale of Common Stock to S-C V-Tel
 
                                      II-2
<PAGE>   101
 
Investments, L.P. In December 1993, the Company sold 100,000 shares of Common
Stock to an unaffiliated accredited investor in exchange for consideration in
the amount of $450,000. Additionally, in October and December 1993, the Company
issued an aggregate of 105,840 shares of Common Stock to a former officer of the
Company. Such shares were issued as partial payment of finder's fees owed to
such former officer in connection with the sale of Common Stock to S-C V-Tel
Investments, L.P. and the sale of Common Stock in December 1993 to an accredited
investor.
 
     In April 1994, the Company sold 3,210,808 shares of Common Stock to COMSAT
Investments, Inc., a principal stockholder, for consideration in an aggregate
amount of $8,000,000 and warrants, for consideration in an aggregate amount of
$1,000, to purchase certain shares of Common Stock. No warrants were exercised
prior to expiration on October 15, 1995.
 
     In January 1995, the Company issued 30,000 shares of restricted Common
Stock to a former director and officer of the Company in exchange for services
rendered on behalf of the Company by him. The interest of such former director
and officer in such shares vested in full as of July 29, 1996.
 
     In June 1996, the Company issued 50,000 shares of restricted Common Stock
to each of a former director and officer of the Company and a current director
and officer. The Company issued restricted shares of Common Stock to each of
them in exchange for services rendered on behalf of the Company by each of them.
The interest of such former director and officer in such shares vested in full
as of July 29, 1996.
 
     The Company relied on Rule 701 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended
(the "Securities Act") for an exemption from the registration requirements under
the Securities Act for the shares of Common Stock issued to the Company's
officer and former officers. For each of the other sales described above, the
Company relied on Section 4(2) of the Securities Act for an exemption from the
registration requirements. No brokers or underwriters were involved in any of
these issuances or sales. All certificates for unregistered shares of Common
Stock bear restrictive legends. In connection with each of the offerings and
sales described above, each of the purchasers represented that they were
purchasing such securities for investment without a view towards resale.
 
     In December 1994, the Company sold 12,070 units (the "Units"), each Unit
consisting of ten 15% Senior Discount Notes due 2005 and 361 shares of
non-voting Class A Common Stock. The aggregate offering price was $74,993,324,
of which amount $57,999,971 was attributed to the Notes and $16,993,353 was
attributed to the Class A Common Stock. The Company relied upon Rule 144A
promulgated under the Securities Act for an exemption from registration for the
sale of these securities. In connection with such issuance of securities, Morgan
Stanley & Co. Incorporated acted as the placement agent. The compensation, in
the form of discounts and commissions, paid to Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
for its services as the placement agent was $3,339,600.
 
     In December 1995, after the Units had separated, each outstanding Note was
exchanged for a 15% Senior Discount Note due 2005 which were registered under
the Securities Act. Each share of Class A Common Stock will automatically
convert into a share of Common Stock upon the consummation of the Offerings.
 
ITEM 16.  EXHIBITS AND CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
     (A) EXHIBITS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.                                        DESCRIPTION
- ------------      -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<C>          <C>  <S>
 1.1          --  Form of U.S. Underwriting Agreement between the Company and the U.S.
                  Underwriters.*
 1.2          --  Form of International Underwriting Agreement between the Company and the
                  International Underwriters.*
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-3
<PAGE>   102
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.                                        DESCRIPTION
- ------------      -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>  <C>
 3.1(i)(a)    --  Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, as amended (filed as Exhibit 3.1
                  to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed
                  on May 24, 1995).**
 3.1(i)(b)    --  Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company.*
 3.1(ii)(a)   --  Bylaws of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
 3.1(ii)(b)   --  Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company.*
 4.1          --  See Exhibit numbers 3.1(i)(a), 3.1(i)(b), 3.1(ii)(a) and 3.1(ii)(b) for
                  provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws of the Company
                  defining the rights of the holders of Common Stock.
 4.2          --  Indenture, dated as of December 15, 1994, between the Company and United
                  States Trust Company of New York, as Trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
 4.3          --  Notes Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December 15, 1994, between
                  the Company and Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated in connection with the
                  Company's 15% Senior Discount Notes due 2005 (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33- 92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).**
 5.1          --  Opinion of Kelley Drye & Warren LLP (including the consent of such firm) as
                  to the validity of the securities being offered.*
10.1          --  Employment Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, and as further amended
                  as of April 5, 1994, between the Company and Martin Varsavsky (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).+**
10.2          --  Expatriate Agreement, dated August 22, 1995, between the Company and Michael
                  Mahoney (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K
                  for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995, filed on April 1, 1996).+**
10.3          --  Placement Agreement, dated as of December 15, 1994, between the Company and
                  Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**
10.4          --  Common Stock Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December 15, 1994,
                  among the Company, Martin Varsavsky, Juan Manuel Aisemberg and Morgan Stanley
                  & Co. Incorporated in connection with the Company's shares of non-voting
                  Class A Common Stock (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.5          --  The Company's 1993 Flexible Stock Incentive Plan, dated as of September 29,
                  1993 (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form
                  S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).+**
10.6          --  Carrier Contract, dated as of May 3, 1993, between the Company and AT&T Corp.
                  (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.7          --  MCI Carrier Agreement, dated as of January 1, 1995, between the Company and
                  MCI Telecommunications Corporation (filed as Exhibit 10.7 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**
10.8          --  Mercury Carrier Services Agreement, dated as of March 1, 1994, between the
                  Company and Mercury Communications Limited (filed as Exhibit 10.8 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-4
<PAGE>   103
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.                                        DESCRIPTION
- ------------      -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>  <C>
10.9          --  Provision and Management Facilities Agreement, dated as of October 17, 1994,
                  between the Company and Mercury Communications Limited (filed as Exhibit 10.9
                  to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed
                  on May 24, 1995).**
10.10         --  Managed Telecommunications Network Agreement, dated as of February 5, 1993,
                  between the Company and TMI USA, Inc. (Delaware) (filed as Exhibit 10.10 to
                  the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).**
10.11         --  Representative Agreement, dated as of June 1, 1993, and as amended as of
                  April 19, 1995, between the Company and Maximiliano Fernandez (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.11 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.12         --  Representative Agreement, dated as of April 23, 1993, between the Company and
                  Viatel de Colombia Comunicaciones S.A. (filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
10.13         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended as of
                  April 5, 1994, and as further amended as of December 21, 1994, between the
                  Company and S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 10.13 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
10.14         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 5, 1994, and as amended as of
                  December 21, 1994, between the Company and COMSAT Investments, Inc. (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.15         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 3, 1993, between the Company
                  and Herald L. Ritch.
10.16         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 1993, between the Company
                  and Robert Conrads (filed as Exhibit 10.16 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.17         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 9, 1993, between the Company
                  and Robert Conrads (filed as Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.18         --  Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of April 5, 1994, and as amended as of
                  November 22, 1994, by and among the Company, Martin Varsavsky, Juan Manuel
                  Aisemberg and COMSAT Investments, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
10.19         --  Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended as of
                  December 9, 1993 and as further amended as of April 5, 1994, November 22,
                  1994 and December 21, 1994, by and among the Company, Martin Varsavsky and
                  S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P. (filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**
10.20         --  Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 8, 1994, between the Company and ECI
                  Telecom, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.22 to the Company's Registration Statement
                  on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.21         --  Carrier Digital Services Agreement, dated as of November 29, 1994, between
                  the Company and Norline Communications, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.23 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May
                  24, 1995).**
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-5
<PAGE>   104
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.                                        DESCRIPTION
- ------------      -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>  <C>
10.22         --  Commercial Lease Agreement, dated as of November 1, 1993, and Addendum, dated
                  as of December 8, 1994, between the Company and 123rd Street Partnership in
                  connection with the Company's premises located in Omaha, Nebraska (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.24 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.23         --  Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 27, 1993, between the Company
                  and Sitel Corporation (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.24         --  Memorandum of Understanding, dated as of August 4, 1994, between the Company
                  and TMI USA, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.25         --  Settlement Agreement, dated as of August 4, 1994, between the Company and TMI
                  USA, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to the Company's Registration Statement on
                  Form S-4, File No. 33- 92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.26         --  Release and Settlement Agreement, dated as of August 1, 1994, between the
                  Company and AT&T Corp. (filed as Exhibit 10.29 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.27         --  Termination Agreement, dated August 4, 1995, between the Company and
                  Telemedia International, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.31 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**
10.28         --  Facilities Management and Services Agreement, dated as of August 4, 1995,
                  between Viatel U.K. Limited and Telemedia International Ltd. (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.32 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.29         --  Agreement of Lease, dated August 7, 1995, between the Company and Joseph P.
                  Day Realty Corp. (filed as Exhibit 10.33 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**
10.30         --  Severance Agreement, dated July 31, 1996, between the Company and Alan Levy.
21.1          --  Subsidiaries of the Company.*
23.1          --  Consent of Kelley Drye & Warren LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).*
23.2          --  Consent of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP.
23.3          --  Consent of Edward Isaacs & Company LLP.
24.1          --  Power of Attorney (included on page II-8 hereof).
27.1          --  Financial Data Schedule (December 31, 1995).
27.2          --  Financial Data Schedule (March 31, 1996).
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
*  To be filed by amendment.
 
** Incorporated herein by reference.
 
+  Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
 
     (B) FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
          Schedule II -- Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
 
     All other schedules are omitted because they are inapplicable or the
requested information is shown in the consolidated financial statements or
related notes.
 
                                      II-6
<PAGE>   105
 
ITEM 17.  UNDERTAKINGS
 
     The Company hereby undertakes to provide to the Underwriters at the closing
specified in the Underwriting Agreement, certificates in such denominations and
registered in such names as required by the Underwriters to permit prompt
delivery to each purchaser.
 
     Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act
may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Company
pursuant to provisions described in Item 14 above, or otherwise, the Company has
been advised that in the opinion of the Commission such indemnification is
against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore,
unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such
liabilities (other than the payment by the Company of expenses incurred or paid
by a director, officer or controlling person of the Company in the successful
defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer
or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the
Company will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled
by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the
question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as
expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication
of such issue.
 
     The Company hereby undertakes (1) that for purposes of determining any
liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of
prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule
430A and contained in the form of prospectus filed by the Company pursuant to
Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be
part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective;
and (2) that for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities
Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be
deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
                                      II-7
<PAGE>   106
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
     In accordance with the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed
on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of New
York, State of New York, on the 7th day of August, 1996.
 
                                          VIATEL, INC.
 
                                          By: /s/ MARTIN VARSAVSKY
                                              --------------------------------- 
                                              Martin Varsavsky
                                              President and Chief Executive
                                                Officer
 
                               POWER OF ATTORNEY
 
     KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each individual whose signature
appears below constitutes and appoints Michael J. Mahoney, Allan L. Shaw and
Sheldon M. Goldman, and each of them, as his true and lawful attorneys-in-fact
and agents for the undersigned, with full power of substitution, for and in the
name, place and stead of the undersigned to sign and file with the Securities
and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, (i) any
and all pre-effective and post-effective amendments to this registration
statement, (ii) any registration statement relating to this offering that is to
be effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended, (iii) any exhibits to any such registration statement or
pre-effective or post-effective amendments, (iv) any and all applications and
other documents in connection with any such registration statement or
pre-effective or post-effective amendments, and (v) generally to do all things
and perform any and all acts and things whatsoever requisite and necessary or
desirable to enable Viatel, Inc. to comply with the provisions of the Securities
Act of 1933, as amended, and all requirements of the Securities and Exchange
Commission.
 
     In accordance with the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended, this Registration Statement was signed on the 7th day of August, 1996,
by the following persons in the capacities indicated:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  SIGNATURE                                        TITLE(S)
- ---------------------------------------------   ----------------------------------------------
<S>                                             <C>
            /s/ MARTIN VARSAVSKY                President, Chief Executive Officer and
- ---------------------------------------------   Director (Principal Executive Officer)
              Martin Varsavsky

           /s/ MICHAEL J. MAHONEY               Executive Vice President, Operations and
- ---------------------------------------------   Technology; Managing Director, International
             Michael J. Mahoney                 and Director

              /s/ ALLAN L. SHAW                 Vice President, Finance; Chief Financial
- ---------------------------------------------   Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting
                Allan L. Shaw                   Officer) and Director

             /s/ PAUL G. PIZZANI                Director
- ---------------------------------------------
               Paul G. Pizzani

              /s/ W. JAMES PEET                 Director
- ---------------------------------------------
                W. James Peet
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-8
<PAGE>   107
 
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SEQUENTIALLY
                                                                                        NUMBERED
EXHIBIT NO.                                  DESCRIPTION                                  PAGE
- ------------      ------------------------------------------------------------------  ------------
<S>          <C>  <C>                                                                 <C>
 1.1          --  Form of U.S. Underwriting Agreement between the Company and the
                  U.S. Underwriters.*...............................................
 1.2          --  Form of International Underwriting Agreement between the Company
                  and the International Underwriters.*..............................
 3.1(i)(a)    --  Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, as amended (filed as
                  Exhibit 3.1 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
 3.1(i)(b)    --  Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the
                  Company.*.........................................................
 3.1(ii)(a)   --  Bylaws of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).**..................................................
 3.1(ii)(b)   --  Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company.*......................
 4.1          --  See Exhibit numbers 3.1(i)(a), 3.1(i)(b), 3.1(ii)(a) and
                  3.1(ii)(b) for provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and
                  Bylaws of the Company defining the rights of the holders of Common
                  Stock. ...........................................................
 4.2          --  Indenture, dated as of December 15, 1994, between the Company and
                  United States Trust Company of New York, as Trustee (filed as
                  Exhibit 4.2 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
 4.3          --  Notes Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December 15,
                  1994, between the Company and Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated in
                  connection with the Company's 15% Senior Discount Notes due 2005
                  (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to the Company's Registration Statement on
                  Form S-4, File No. 33- 92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**...........
 5.1          --  Opinion of Kelley Drye & Warren LLP (including the consent of such
                  firm) as to the validity of the securities being offered.*........
10.1          --  Employment Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, and
                  as further amended as of April 5, 1994, between the Company
                  and Martin Varsavsky (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).+**.................................................
10.2          --  Expatriate Agreement, dated August 22, 1995, between the Company
                  and Michael Mahoney (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company's Annual
                  Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995,
                  filed on April 1, 1996).+**.......................................
10.3          --  Placement Agreement, dated as of December 15, 1994, between the
                  Company and Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (filed as Exhibit
                  10.3 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**...............................
10.4          --  Common Stock Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December
                  15, 1994, among the Company, Martin Varsavsky, Juan Manuel
                  Aisemberg and Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated in connection with
                  the Company's shares of non-voting Class A Common Stock (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.4 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   108
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SEQUENTIALLY
                                                                                        NUMBERED
EXHIBIT NO.                                  DESCRIPTION                                  PAGE
- ------------      ------------------------------------------------------------------  ------------
<S>          <C>  <C>                                                                 <C>
10.5          --  The Company's 1993 Flexible Stock Incentive Plan, dated as of
                  September 29, 1993 (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).+**.................................................
10.6          --  Carrier Contract, dated as of May 3, 1993, between the Company and
                  AT&T Corp. (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**..........................................................
10.7          --  MCI Carrier Agreement, dated as of January 1, 1995, between the
                  Company and MCI Telecommunications Corporation (filed as Exhibit
                  10.7 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No.
                  33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**...............................
10.8          --  Mercury Carrier Services Agreement, dated as of March 1, 1994,
                  between the Company and Mercury Communications Limited (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.8 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
10.9          --  Provision and Management Facilities Agreement, dated as of October
                  17, 1994, between the Company and Mercury Communications Limited
                  (filed as Exhibit 10.9 to the Company's Registration Statement on
                  Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**............
10.10         --  Managed Telecommunications Network Agreement, dated as of February
                  5, 1993, between the Company and TMI USA, Inc. (Delaware) (filed
                  as Exhibit 10.10 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form
                  S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**.................
10.11         --  Representative Agreement, dated as of June 1, 1993, and as amended
                  as of April 19, 1995, between the Company and Maximiliano
                  Fernandez (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**..........................................................
10.12         --  Representative Agreement, dated as of April 23, 1993, between the
                  Company and Viatel de Colombia Comunicaciones S.A. (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.12 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
10.13         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as
                  amended as of April 5, 1994, and as further amended as of December
                  21, 1994, between the Company and S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P.
                  (filed as Exhibit 10.13 to the Company's Registration Statement on
                  Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**............
10.14         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of April 5, 1994, and as
                  amended as of December 21, 1994, between the Company and COMSAT
                  Investments, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).**..................................................
10.15         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 3, 1993, between
                  the Company and Herald L. Ritch...................................
10.16         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 1993, between the
                  Company and Robert Conrads (filed as Exhibit 10.16 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   109
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SEQUENTIALLY
                                                                                        NUMBERED
EXHIBIT NO.                                  DESCRIPTION                                  PAGE
- ------------      ------------------------------------------------------------------  ------------
<S>          <C>  <C>                                                                 <C>
10.17         --  Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 9, 1993, between
                  the Company and Robert Conrads (filed as Exhibit 10.17 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.18         --  Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of April 5, 1994, and as amended
                  as of November 22, 1994, by and among the Company, Martin
                  Varsavsky, Juan Manuel Aisemberg and COMSAT Investments, Inc.
                  (filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the Company's Registration Statement on
                  Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**............
10.19         --  Shareholders' Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as
                  amended as of December 9, 1993 and as further amended as of April
                  5, 1994, November 22, 1994 and December 21, 1994, by and among the
                  Company, Martin Varsavsky and S-C V-Tel Investments, L.P. (filed
                  as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form
                  S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**.................
10.20         --  Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 8, 1994, between the
                  Company and ECI Telecom, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.22 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.21         --  Carrier Digital Services Agreement, dated as of November 29, 1994,
                  between the Company and Norline Communications, Inc. (filed as
                  Exhibit 10.23 to the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4,
                  File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24, 1995).**......................
10.22         --  Commercial Lease Agreement, dated as of November 1, 1993, and
                  Addendum, dated as of December 8, 1994, between the Company and
                  123rd Street Partnership in connection with the Company's premises
                  located in Omaha, Nebraska (filed as Exhibit 10.24 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.23         --  Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 27, 1993, between the
                  Company and Sitel Corporation (filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.24         --  Memorandum of Understanding, dated as of August 4, 1994, between
                  the Company and TMI USA, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.27 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.25         --  Settlement Agreement, dated as of August 4, 1994, between the
                  Company and TMI USA, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.28 to the Company's
                  Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33- 92696, filed on
                  May 24, 1995).**..................................................
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   110
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      SEQUENTIALLY
                                                                                        NUMBERED
EXHIBIT NO.                                  DESCRIPTION                                  PAGE
- ------------      ------------------------------------------------------------------  ------------
<S>          <C>  <C>                                                                 <C>
10.26         --  Release and Settlement Agreement, dated as of August 1, 1994,
                  between the Company and AT&T Corp. (filed as Exhibit 10.29 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.27         --  Termination Agreement, dated August 4, 1995, between the Company
                  and Telemedia International, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.31 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.28         --  Facilities Management and Services Agreement, dated as of August
                  4, 1995, between Viatel U.K. Limited and Telemedia International
                  Ltd. (filed as Exhibit 10.32 to the Company's Registration
                  Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696, filed on May 24,
                  1995).**..........................................................
10.29         --  Agreement of Lease, dated August 7, 1995, between the Company and
                  Joseph P. Day Realty Corp. (filed as Exhibit 10.33 to the
                  Company's Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-92696,
                  filed on May 24, 1995).**.........................................
10.30         --  Severance Agreement, dated July 31, 1996, between the Company and
                  Alan Levy.........................................................
21.1          --  Subsidiaries of the Company.*.....................................
23.1          --  Consent of Kelley Drye & Warren LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).*...
23.2          --  Consent of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP. ................................
23.3          --  Consent of Edward Isaacs & Company LLP. ..........................
24.1          --  Power of Attorney (included on page II-8 hereof). ................
27.1          --  Financial Data Schedule (December 31, 1995). .....................
27.2          --  Financial Data Schedule (March 31, 1996). ........................
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
*  To be filed by amendment.
 
** Incorporated herein by reference.
 
+  Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

<PAGE>   1
                                                                  Exhibit 10.15


                            STOCK PURCHASE AGREEMENT

        THIS STOCK PURCHASE AGREEMENT is dated as of December 3, 1993, by and
between VIA USA, LTD., a Colorado corporation d/b/a VIATEL (the "Company"), and
Herald L. Ritch, an individual (the "Purchaser").

        In consideration of the mutual covenants hereinafter set forth and for
other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby
acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:

    1.  Authorization of Shares; Sale and Purchase of Shares.

        1.1  Authorization of Shares. Before the Closing (as defined in Section
2.1), the Company will take such corporate action as is required to authorize
the issuance and sale to the Purchaser of sufficient shares of its common stock
with no par value (the "Common Stock") to satisfy the Company's obligations
hereunder to deliver Common Stock to the Purchaser.

        1.2  Sale and Purchase of Shares. Subject to the terms and conditions
hereof, at the Closing, the Company will issue and sell to the Purchaser, and
the Purchaser will purchase from the Company, 100,000 shares of Common Stock of
the Company for a purchase price of $500,000 (the "Purchase Price"). The
100,000 shares of Common Stock of the Company sold hereunder are  hereinafter
referred to as the "Shares".

    2.  Closing.

        2.1  Closing. The closing of the purchase and sale of the Shares (the
"Closing") shall be held at the offices of the Company, 800 Third Avenue, New
York, New York at 10:00 a.m. on December 9, 1993, or on such other date as the
Company and the Purchaser shall agree (the "Closing Date").

        2.2  Delivery of Shares. At the Closing, the Company shall deliver to
the Purchaser a certificate registered in the Purchaser's name representing the
Shares. 

        2.3  Payment for the Shares. At the Closing, the Purchaser shall pay
the Purchase Price by wire transfer of immediately available funds to a bank
account designated by the Company.

    3.  Representations and Warranties of the Company.

        The Company hereby represents and warrants to the Purchaser as follows:

        3.1  Organization and Standing; Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws.
The Company is a corporation duly organized and existing under the laws of the
State of Colorado and is in good standing under such laws. The Company has the
requisite corporate power to own and operate its properties and assets, and to
carry on its business as presently conducted in all material respects. The
Company is duly qualified to do business as a foreign



<PAGE>   2
corporation in each jurisdiction in which the failure to be so qualified would
have a materially adverse impact on the business or financial condition of the
Company. The Company has furnished the Purchaser with copies of its Articles of
Incorporation and Bylaws, as amended to date. Said copies are true, correct,
and complete.

        3.2     Corporate Power. The Company has all requisite legal and
corporate power to execute and deliver this Agreement, to sell and issue Shares
hereunder, and to carry out and perform its obligations under the terms of this
Agreement.

        3.3     Subsidiaries. The Company has no Subsidiaries (as defined in
Section 7.13 below).

        3.4     Capitalization. Immediately following the closing of this
transaction, the authorized capital of the Company will consist of 20,000,000
shares of Common Stock, without par value, of which 12,830,019 shares will be
validly issued and outstanding, fully paid and nonassessable.

                Except as set forth on Exhibit A hereto, there are no options,
warrants, conversion privileges, preemptive rights, or other rights currently
outstanding to purchase any of the authorized but unissued stock of the
Company, except for the rights created by this agreement.

        3.5     Authorization. All corporate action on the part of the Company,
its directors and shareholders necessary for (a) the authorization, execution,
delivery and performance of this Agreement by the Company, and (b) the
authorization, sale, issuance and delivery of the Shares will have been taken
prior to the Closing. This Agreement, when executed and delivered by the
Company, shall constitute a valid and binding obligation of the Company
enforceable in accordance with its terms.

        3.6     Validity of Stock. The Shares, when issued, sold, and delivered
in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, shall be validly issued, fully
paid, and nonassessable.

        3.7     Financial Statements. The Company has delivered to the
Purchaser an unaudited balance sheet of the Company dated December 31, 1992 and
an unaudited comparative income statement by month for the twelve months ended
December 1992 (the "Financial Statements"). The Financial Statements have been
prepared in good faith and fairly present the financial condition of the
Company for the fiscal year then ended and include all liabilities of the
Company at the end of such fiscal year.

        3.8     Finder's Fee. Except for a finder's fee payable by the Company
to Robert Conrads, no selling concession, fee or other remuneration is being
paid to any third party in connection with the sale of the Shares pursuant to
this Agreement.

        3.9     Limited Representations. Except as set forth in this Section 3,
neither the Company nor any of its directors and officers has made any
representations to the Purchaser concerning the Company or the merits of an
investment therein by the Purchaser.

                                     Page 2

<PAGE>   3
   4. Representations and Warranties of the Purchaser: Restrictions on
      Transfer of the Shares; Covenants of the Purchaser.

        4.1 Representations and Warranties of the Purchaser. The Purchaser
hereby represents and warrants to the Company as follows:

           (a) The Purchaser has all requisite legal power to execute and
deliver this Agreement, to purchase the Shares hereunder, and to carry out and
perform his obligations under the terms of this Agreement.

           (b) All action on the part of the Purchaser for the authorization,
execution, delivery and performance by the Purchaser of this Agreement has been
taken, and this Agreement constitutes a valid and binding obligation of the
Purchaser, enforceable in accordance with its terms.

           (c) The Purchaser is acquiring the Shares in his own name for
investment for his own account, not as a nominee or agent, and not with a view
to, or for resale in connection with, any distribution. The Purchaser further
represents that he does not have any contract, undertaking, agreement, or
arrangement with any person to sell, transfer, or grant participations to such
person, or to any third person, with respect to any of the Shares. The
Purchaser understands and acknowledges that the Shares have not been registered
under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), on the
ground that the sale provided for in this Agreement is exempt from registration
under the Securities Act, and that the Seller's and the Company's reliance on
such exemption is predicated on the Purchaser's representations set forth 
herein.

           (d) The Purchaser acknowledges that the Shares must be held by him
indefinitely unless subsequently registered under the Securities Act or an
exemption from such registration is available. The Purchaser is aware of the
provisions of Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act which permit only
limited resale of shares purchased in a private placement subject to the
satisfaction of certain conditions set forth under such Rule.

           (e) The Purchaser understands and acknowledges that no public market
now exists for any of the Shares and that there is no assurance that a public
market will ever exist for the Shares.

           (f) The Purchaser has had an opportunity to discuss the Company's
business, management and financial affairs with the Company's management and an
opportunity to review the Company's facilities. The Purchaser understands that
such discussions were intended to describe the aspects of the Company's
business and prospects which it believes to be material but were not
necessarily a thorough or exhaustive description and that the Company makes no
representation and warranties relative to the Company other than those set
forth in Section 3 of this Agreement.

           (g) The Purchaser is experienced in evaluating and investing in
companies such as the Company. The Purchaser is a sophisticated investor with
such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters so as to be
capable of evaluating the merits and


                                     Page 3




        
<PAGE>   4
risks of a prospective investment in the Shares and who is capable of bearing
the economic risks of such investment.

                (h)     The Purchaser has been solely responsible for his "due
diligence" investigation of the Company and the Company's management and
business, and for the analysis of the merits and risks of this investment and
of the fairness and desirability of the terms of the investment. In taking any
action or performing any role relative to the arranging of the proposed
investment, the Purchaser has acted solely in his own interest, and neither
the Purchaser nor any of his agents or employees has acted as an agent of the
Company or as an issuer, underwriter, broker, dealer or investment advisor
relative to any of the Shares.

                (i)     Except for a finder's fee payable by the Company to
Robert Conrads, no selling concession, fee or other remuneration is being paid
to any third party in connection with the sale of the Shares pursuant to this
Agreement. 

                (j)     The Purchaser is a natural person and that the
information set forth on the attached Exhibit B with respect to him is true and
complete. 

                (k)     The Purchaser has reviewed the attached Exhibit C for
the purpose of determining whether he is an "accredited investor" as such term
is defined in Regulation D under the Securities Act.

        4.2     Legends. The transfer of the Shares is restricted by the
provisions of the Securities Act. The certificate representing the Shares shall
be endorsed with the following legend:

        THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED
        UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE "ACT"), AND MAY NOT BE
        SOLD, TRANSFERRED, ASSIGNED OR HYPOTHECATED UNLESS THERE IS AN EFFECTIVE
        REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE ACT COVERING SUCH SECURITIES, THE SALE
        IS MADE IN ACCORDANCE WITH RULE 144 OR ITS SUCCESSOR RULE UNDER THE ACT,
        OR THE COMPANY RECEIVES AN OPINION OF COUNSEL SATISFACTORY TO THE
        COMPANY THAT AN EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION IS AVAILABLE.

The certificate representing the Shares shall also bear any legend required by
any applicable state securities law. The Company need not register a transfer of
the Shares unless the conditions specified in the foregoing legend are
satisfied. The Company may also instruct its transfer agent not to register the
transfer of any of the Shares unless the conditions specified in the foregoing
legend are satisfied.

        4.3     Covenants of the Purchaser. The Purchaser agrees to consent in
writing to all corporate action recommended by the Board of Directors of the
Company in connection with (i) any restructuring or recapitalization of the
Company, (ii) any offering for sale of, or sale of, additional securities of
the Company, or (iii) any merger, sale, consolidation or other similar
transaction involving the Company. The Purchaser agrees to consent in writing
to the

                                     Page 4
<PAGE>   5
election of any and all directors nominated by the holders of a majority of the
Common Stock of the Company. The provisions of this Section 4.3 will terminate
in the event of a public offering of the Company's Common Stock pursuant to the
Securities Act.

    5.  Conditions to Closing.
        
        5.1     Condition's to the Purchaser's Obligations at the Closing.  The
Purchaser's obligation to purchase the Shares at the Closing is subject to the
fulfillment on or prior to the Closing Date of the following conditions, any of
which may be waived in whole or in part by the Purchaser:

                (a)  The representations and warranties made by the Company
herein shall be true and correct when made, and shall be true and correct on
the Closing Date with the same force and effect as if they had been made on and
as of the Closing Date; and the Company shall have performed and complied with
all agreements and conditions herein required to be performed or complied with
by it on or prior to the Closing Date and all documents incident thereto shall
be satisfactory in form and content to the Purchaser.

                (b)  The Company shall have obtained all consents, permits and
waivers necessary or appropriate for consummation of the transactions
contemplated by this Agreement which need to be obtained prior to the Closing 
Date.

                (c)  The Company shall have delivered to the Purchaser a
certificate, executed by an officer of the Company, dated the Closing Date,
certifying to the fulfillment of the conditions specified in subsections (a)
and (b) of this Section 5.1.

                (d)  The Purchaser and Juan Manuel Aisemberg ("Aisemberg")
shall have entered into, and consummated the transactions contemplated by, a
stock purchase agreement whereby Aisemberg will sell to the Purchaser 90,000
shares of Common Stock (the "Aisemberg Stock Purchase Agreement").

                (e)  The Purchaser and Aisemberg shall have entered into an
option agreement pursuant to which Aisemberg will grant the Purchaser an option
to purchase 41,482 shares of Common Stock of the Company (the "Option 
Agreement").

                (f)  The Purchaser and Martin Varsavsky shall have entered into
a participation agreement whereby Martin Varsavsky will grant the Purchaser
certain rights concerning the sale of shares of Common Stock of the Company
(the "Participation Agreement").

        5.2     Conditions to the Company's Obligations at the Closing.  The
Company's obligation to issue and sell the Shares at the Closing is subject to
the fulfillment on or prior to the Closing Date of the following conditions,
any of which may be waived in whole or in part by the Company:

                (a)  The representations and warranties made by the Purchaser
herein shall be true and correct when made, and shall be true and correct on
the Closing Date with the same force and effect as if they had been made on and
as of the Closing Date; and the Purchaser shall

                                    Page 5



<PAGE>   6
have performed and complied with all agreements and conditions herein required
to be performed or complied with by him on or prior to the Closing Date and all
documents incident thereto shall be satisfactory in form and content to the
Company.

        (b) The Company shall have obtained all consents, permits and waivers
necessary or appropriate for consummation of the transactions contemplated by
this Agreement which need to be obtained prior to the Closing.

        (c) At the Closing, the purchase of the Shares by the Purchaser
hereunder shall be legally permitted by all laws and regulations to which the
Purchaser or the Company are subject.

        (d) The Purchaser shall have delivered to the Company a certificate,
dated the Closing Date, certifying to the fulfillment of the conditions
specified in subsections (a) and (c) of this Section 5.2.

        (e) The Purchaser and Aisemberg shall have entered into, and
consummated the transactions contemplated by, the Aisemberg Stock Purchase
Agreement.

        (f) The Purchaser and Aisemberg shall have entered into the Option
Agreement.

        (g) The Purchaser and Martin Varsavsky shall have entered into the
Participation Agreement.

6. Registration Rights.

        6.1 Definitions. For purposes of this Section 6:

        (a) The terms "register", "registered", and "registration" refer to a
registration effected by preparing and filing a registration statement or
similar document in compliance with the Securities Act, or the securities laws
of any jurisdiction other than the United States, and the declaration or
ordering of effectiveness of such registration statement or document, or
similar action in such other jurisdiction; and

        (b) The term "Registrable Securities" means (1) the Shares, and (2) any
Common Stock issued as (or issuable upon the conversion or exercise of any
warrant, right or other security which is issued as) a dividend or other
distribution with respect to, or in exchange for or in replacement of the
Shares.

        6.2 "Piggy-back" Registrations. If, at any time after an IPO (as
defined below in Section 7.13), the Company proposes to register any securities
under the Securities Act in connection with any offering of its securities,
whether or not for its own account (other than a registration statement filed
with respect to the issuance of Common Stock, or securities convertible into or
exchangeable for Common Stock, or rights to acquire Common Stock, granted or to
be granted to employees of the Company or its Affiliates), the Company shall
furnish prompt written notice to the Purchaser of its intention to effect such
registration and the intended method of distribution in connection therewith.
On no more than two occasions,

                                     Page 6
<PAGE>   7
upon the written request of the Purchaser made to the Company within 30 days
after the receipt of such a notice by the Company, the Company shall, subject
to Section 6.6, include in such registration up to 33 1/3% of the Registrable
Securities owned of record by the Purchaser (a "Piggy-back Registration").

        6.3 Obligations of the Company. Whenever the Company is required under
this Section 6 to effect the registration of any Registrable Securities, the
Company shall, as expeditiously as may be practicable:

        (a) Prepare and file with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
"SEC"), or similar authority in a jurisdiction other than the United States, as
the case may be, a registration statement with respect to such Registrable
Securities and use its best efforts to cause such registration statement to
become effective, and keep such registration statement effective for up to 60
days.

        (b) Prepare and file with the SEC, or similar authority in a
jurisdiction other than the United states, as the case may be, such amendments
and supplements to such registration statement and the prospectus used in
connection with such registration statement as may be necessary to comply with
the provisions of applicable law with respect to the disposition of all
securities covered by such registration statement.

        (c) Furnish to the Purchaser such number of copies of a prospectus,
including a preliminary prospectus, in conformity with requirements of
applicable law, and such other documents as he may reasonably request in order
to facilitate the disposition of Registrable Securities owned by him.

        (d) Use its best efforts to register and qualify the securities covered
by such registration statement under such other securities laws of such
jurisdictions in the country in which the securities are being registered as
shall be reasonably requested by the Purchaser (such as, in the case of the
United States, under state blue sky laws); provided that the Company shall not
be required in connection therewith or as to condition thereto to qualify to do
business or to file a general consent to service of process in any such
jurisdictions.

        (e) In the event of any underwritten public offering, enter into and
perform its obligations under an underwriting agreement, in usual and customary
form, with the managing underwriter of such offering. The Purchaser shall also
enter into and perform his obligations under such an agreement.

        (f) Notify the Purchaser, at any time when a prospectus relating
thereto is required to be delivered under applicable law, of the happening of
any event as a result of which the prospectus included in such registration
statement, as then in effect, includes an untrue statement of a material fact
or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
make the statements therein not misleading in the light of the circumstances
then existing.

        6.4 Furnish Information. It shall be a condition precedent to the
obligation of the Company to take any action pursuant to this Section 6 that
the Purchaser shall furnish to the

                                     Page 7
<PAGE>   8
Company such information regarding himself, the Registrable Securities held by
him, and the intended method of disposition of such securities as shall be
required to effect the registration of the Registrable Securities.

        6.5 Expenses of Registration. The Company shall bear and pay all
expenses incurred in connection with any registration, filing or qualification
of Registrable Securities with respect to the registrations made pursuant to
Section 6.2, including, without limitation, all registration, filing, and
qualification fees, printers' and accounting fees, fees and disbursements of
counsel for the Company, but excluding underwriting discounts and commissions
relating to Registrable Securities and fees and disbursements of counsel for
the Purchaser.

        6.6 Underwriting Requirements. In connection with any offering
involving an underwriting of shares of the Company's capital stock, the Company
shall not be required under Section 6.2 to include any of the securities of the
Purchaser in the registration of the securities to be included in such
underwriting, or in such underwriting itself, unless the Purchaser accepts the
terms of the underwriting as agreed upon between the Company and the
underwriters selected by it, and then only in such quantity as the underwriters
determine in their sole discretion will not jeopardize the success of the
offering by the Company. If the total amount of securities, including
Registrable Securities, requested by shareholders to be included in such
offering, whether upon exercise of registration rights or otherwise
(collectively, "secondary securities"), exceeds the number of secondary
securities that the underwriters determine in their sole discretion is
compatible with the success of the offering, then the Company shall be required
to include in the offering only such number of secondary securities, including
Registrable Securities, as the underwriters determine in their sole discretion
will not jeopardize the success of the offering. The secondary securities so
included shall be apportioned among the Purchaser and such other selling
shareholders pro rata in proportion to the total number of secondary
securities, including Registrable Securities, owned by them, respectively, or
in such other proportion as may be agreed to by such shareholders and the
Purchaser. 

        6.7 Delay of Registration. The Purchaser shall not have any right to
obtain or seek an injunction restraining or otherwise delaying any registration
as the result of any controversy that might arise with respect to the
interpretation or implementation of this Section 6.

        6.8 Indemnification. In the event any Registrable Securities are
included in a registration statement under this Section 6:

        (a) To the extent permitted by law, the Company will indemnify and hold
harmless the Purchaser, any underwriter (as defined in the Securities Act or
other applicable law) for the Purchaser and each Person (as defined in Section
7.13 below), if any, who controls the Purchaser or underwriter within the
meaning of the Securities Act or the United States Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act") or other applicable law, against any
losses, claims, damages, or liabilities (joint or several) to which they may
become subject under the Securities Act or other applicable law, insofar as
such losses, claims, damages, or liabilities (or actions in respect thereof)
arise out of or are based upon any of the 

                                     Page 8

 
<PAGE>   9
following statements, omissions or violations (collectively a "Violation"): (i)
any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained
in such registration statement, including any preliminary prospectus or final
prospectus contained therein or any amendments or supplements thereto, (ii) the
omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be
stated therein, or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, or
(iii) any violation or alleged violation by the Company of the Securities Act
or other applicable law, or any rule or regulation promulgated under the
Securities Act or other applicable law; and the Company will pay to the
Purchaser, underwriter or controlling Person any reasonable legal or other
expenses incurred by him in connection with investigating or defending any such
loss, claim, damage, liability, or action; provided that the indemnity
agreement contained in this Section 6.8(a) shall not apply to amounts paid in
settlement of any such loss, claim, damage, liability, or action if such
settlement is effected without the consent of the Company (which consent shall
not be unreasonably withheld), nor shall the Company be liable in any such case
for any such loss, claim, damage, liability, or action to the extent that it
arises out of or is based upon a Violation which occurs in reliance upon and in
conformity with written information furnished expressly for use in connection
with such registration by the Purchaser or such underwriter or controlling
Person. 

        (b) To the extent permitted by law, the Purchaser will indemnify and
hold harmless the Company, each of its directors, each of its officers who has
signed the registration statement, each Person, if any, who controls the
Company within the meaning of the Securities Act or other applicable law, any
underwriter, and any controlling Person of any such underwriter, against any
losses, claims, damages, or liabilities (joint or several) to which any of the
foregoing Persons may become subject, under the Securities Act or other
applicable law, insofar as such losses, claims, damages, or liabilities (or
actions in respect thereto) arise out of or are based upon any Violation, in
each case to the extent (and only to the extent) that such Violation occurs in
reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished by the
Purchaser expressly for use in connection with such registration; and the
Purchaser will pay any reasonable legal or other expenses incurred by any
Person to be indemnified pursuant to this Section 6.8(b), in connection with
investigating or defending any such loss, claim, damage, liability, or action;
provided that the indemnity agreement contained in this Section 6.8(b) shall
not apply to amounts paid in settlement of any such loss, claim, damage,
liability, or action if such settlement is effected without the consent of the
Purchaser, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld; and provided,
further, that in no event shall any indemnity under this Section 6.8(b) exceed
the gross proceeds from the offering received by the Purchaser.

        (c) Promptly after receipt by an indemnified party under this Section
6.8 of notice of the commencement of any action (including any governmental
action), such indemnified party will, if a claim in respect thereof is to be
made against any indemnifying party under this Section 6.8, deliver to the
indemnifying party a written notice of the commencement thereof, and the
indemnifying party shall have the right to participate in, and, to the extent
the indemnifying party so desires, jointly with any other indemnifying party
similarly noticed, to assume the defense thereof with counsel mutually
satisfactory to the parties; provided that an indemnified party (together with
all other indemnified parties which may be represented without conflict by one
counsel) shall have the right to retain one separate counsel, with the fees and
expenses to be paid by the indemnifying party, if representation of such
indemnified

                                     Page 9
<PAGE>   10
party by the counsel retained by the indemnifying party would be inappropriate
due to actual or potential differing interests between such indemnified party
and any other party represented by such counsel in such proceeding. The failure
to deliver written notice to the indemnifying party within a reasonable time of
the commencement of any such action, if prejudicial to its ability to defend
such action, shall relieve such indemnifying party of any liability to the
indemnified party under this Section 6.8, but the omission so to deliver
written notice to the indemnifying party will not relieve it of any liability
that it may have to any indemnified party otherwise than under this Section 6.8.

        (d) The obligations of the Company and the Purchaser under this Section
6.8 shall survive completion of any offering of Registrable Securities under a
registration statement pursuant to this Section 6, and otherwise.

        6.9 Reports. With a view to making available to the Purchaser the
benefits of Rule 144 and 144A of the SEC and any other rule or regulation of
the SEC and the applicable authority in each other jurisdiction where the
Company's securities are registered that may at any time permit the Purchaser
to sell securities of the Company to the public without registration, the
Company agrees to:

        (a) make and keep public information available, as those terms are
understood and defined in Rule 144 or other applicable law, at all times after
90 days after the effective date of the first registration statement filed by
the Company for the offering of its securities to the general public;

        (b) file with the SEC and the applicable authority in each other
jurisdiction where the Company's securities are registered in a timely manner
all reports and other documents required of the Company under the Securities
Act and the Exchange Act, and the similar laws of each such other jurisdiction;
and

        (c) furnish to the Purchaser, so long as the Purchaser beneficially
owns shares of Common Stock, all information distributed to other shareholders
holding less than 10% of the Common Stock.

        6.10 "Market Stand-Off" Agreement. The Purchaser hereby agrees that,
during the duration of the period specified by the Company and an underwriter
of Common Stock or other securities of the Company following the effective date
of a registration statement of the Company (but no longer than nine months), he
shall not, to the extent requested by the Company and such underwriter, directly
or indirectly sell, offer to sell, contract to sell (including, without
limitation, any short sale), grant any option to purchase or otherwise transfer
or dispose of any securities of the Company held by the Purchaser at any time
during such period except Common Stock included in such registration. In order
to enforce the foregoing covenant, the Company may impose stop-transfer
instructions with respect to the Registrable Securities of the Purchaser (and
the shares or securities of every other Person subject to the foregoing
restriction) until the end of such period.

                                    Page 10

<PAGE>   11
                6.11    Termination of Registration Rights. The Purchaser shall
not be entitled to exercise any right provided for in this Section 6 after five
years following the consummation of an IPO except for the right to
indemnification provided herein.

        7.      Miscellaneous.

                7.1     Finders and Brokers. Except for a finder's fee payable
by the Company to Robert Conrads, each party hereby represents and warrants to
the other that neither he nor his representatives have taken, nor will they
take, any action that would cause the other party hereto to have any obligation
or liability to any Person (as defined in Section 7.13 below) for any finders'
fees, brokerage fees, agents' commissions, or like payments in connection with
the transactions contemplated hereby. Each party shall indemnify and hold
harmless the other from any claim that is asserted by any Person for a finder's
fee or like payment with respect to this Agreement arising from any act,
representation or promise of the indemnifying party or its representative.

                7.2     Amendment. Subject to applicable law, this Agreement
may be amended, modified or supplemented only by written agreement of the
parties hereto.

                7.3     Waiver of Compliance. Any failure of the Company, on
the one hand, or the Purchaser on the other, to comply with any provision of
this Agreement may be expressly waived in writing by the Purchaser or the
Company, respectively, but such waiver or failure to insist upon strict
compliance with such provision shall not operate as a waiver of, or estoppel
with respect to, any subsequent or other failure. No failure to exercise and no
delay in exercising any right, remedy, or power hereunder shall operate as a
waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, remedy,
or power hereunder preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the
exercise of any other right, remedy, or power provided herein or by law or in
equity. The waiver by any party of the time for performance of any act or
condition hereunder does not constitute a waiver of the act or condition itself.

                7.4     Expenses; Attorneys' Fees. Each party shall pay all
expenses incurred by him or on his behalf in connection with this Agreement,
any transaction contemplated hereby, or any legal action, arbitration or other
proceeding brought to interpret or enforce the terms of this Agreement.

                7.5     Survival of Representations and Warranties. The
respective representations and warranties of each party contained herein shall
not be deemed waived or otherwise affected by any investigation made by or on
behalf of the other party, and such representations and warranties shall
survive the Closing. All statements contained in this Agreement or in any
exhibit, certificate or other document delivered pursuant hereto shall be
deemed representations or warranties, as the case may be (as such terms are
used in this Agreement), of the party making such statements.

                7.6     Notices. All notices, demands, and other communications
required or permitted hereunder shall be made in writing and shall be deemed to
have been duly given if delivered by hand (against receipt) or by Federal
Express or other recognized international

                                    Page 11
<PAGE>   12
courier or mailed, postage prepaid, certified or registered airmail, return
receipt requested, and addressed:

                to the Company at:

                Martin Varsavsky
                VIA USA, LTD.
                800 Third Avenue
                18th Floor
                New York, New York 10022

                With copies to:

                Joel I. Frank, Esq.
                VIA USA, LTD.
                800 Third Avenue
                18th Floor
                New York, New York 10022

                to the Purchaser at:

                Herald L. Ritch
                10 Fort Hills Lane
                Greenwich, Connecticut 06831

Notice of a change in address shall be effective only when given in accordance
with this Section. All notices complying with this Section shall be deemed to
have been received on the date of delivery or on the third business day after
mailing.

     7.7 Assignment; Successors and Assigns. Except as otherwise provided
herein, the Purchaser agrees with the Company that neither the Purchaser nor the
Company will assign, sell, transfer, delegate, or otherwise dispose of, whether
voluntarily or involuntarily or by operation of law, any right or obligation of
such party under this Agreement. Any purported assignment, transfer, or
delegation in violation of this Section shall be null and void. Subject to the
foregoing limits on assignment and delegation, this Agreement shall be binding
upon and shall inure to the benefit of the parties and their respective
successors and assigns. Except for those enumerated above, this Agreement does
not create, and shall not be construed as creating, any rights or claims
enforceable by any Person not a party to this Agreement.

     7.8 GOVERNING LAW. THE VALIDITY, INTERPRETATION, ENFORCEABILITY, AND
PERFORMANCE OF THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE
WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REGARD TO THE CONFLICTS OF LAW
PRINCIPLES THEREOF.

     7.9 Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of
which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute
one and the same instrument.

                                    Page 12

<PAGE>   13
        7.10  Headings.  The headings of the Sections of this Agreement are for
reference purposes only and shall not constitute a part hereof or affect the
meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.

        7.11  Entire Agreement.  The parties intend that the terms of this
Agreement, including the other documents referred to herein, shall be the final
expression of their agreement with respect to the subject matter hereof and may
not be contradicted by evidence of any prior or contemporaneous agreement. The
parties further intend that this Agreement shall constitute the complete and
exclusive statement of its terms and that no extrinsic evidence whatsoever may
be introduced in any judicial, administrative, or other legal proceeding
involving this Agreement.

        7.12  Severability.  If any provision of this Agreement, or the
application thereof to any Person, place, or circumstance, shall be held by a
court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, unenforceable, or void, the
remainder of this Agreement and such provisions as applied to other Persons,
places, and circumstances shall remain in full force and effect.

        7.13  Certain Definitions.

        "Affiliate" shall mean, with respect to the Purchaser, any Person
directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect
common control with the Purchaser. For the purpose of this definition, the term
"control", when used with respect to any Person, means the power to direct the
management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through
the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise, but only so long
as such Person retains an equity interest in the Person being controlled; and
the terms "controlling" and "controlled" have corresponding meanings.

        "IPO" shall mean an initial public offering of Common Stock under a
registration statement filed under the Securities Act or the applicable
securities law of any jurisdiction outside the United States (other than a
registration statement filed with respect to the issuance of Common Stock, or
securities convertible into or exchangeable for Common Stock, or rights to
acquire Common Stock, granted or to be granted to employees of the Company or
its Affiliates), whether primary or secondary.

        "Person" shall include any individual, partnership, joint venture,
corporation, trust, unincorporated organization, any other entity and any
government or any department or agency thereof, whether acting in an
individual, fiduciary, or other capacity.

                                    Page 13

<PAGE>   14
        "Subsidiary" shall mean, as to any particular parent corporation, any
corporation as to which more than fifty percent of the outstanding stock having
ordinary voting rights or power (and excluding stock having voting rights only
upon the occurrence of a contingency unless and until such contingency occurs
and such rights are to be exercised) at the time is owned or controlled,
directly or indirectly, by such parent corporation and/or by one or more 
subsidiaries.

        IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have caused this Agreement to be duly
executed as of the date first above written.


                                               VIA USA, LTD.

                                        By:    /s/ David S. Hershberg
                                               -----------------------------
                                        Name:  David S. Hershberg
                                        Title: Executive Vice President

                                               /s/ Herald L. Ritch
                                               -----------------------------
                                               HERALD L. RITCH,
                                               an individual


                                    Page 14



<PAGE>   15
                                EXHIBIT A

1.      Pursuant to a Warrant Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993,
between the Company and S-C V-TEL Investments, L.P., a Delaware limited
partnership ("S-C V-TEL"), S-C V-TEL has the right, upon certain terms and
conditions (including time periods), to acquire a number of shares of Common
Stock such that when aggregated with its present investment in the Company, S-C
V-TEL could own a maximum of 33 1/3% of the outstanding shares of Common Stock.

2.      Robert Conrads, who has acted as a finder for the Company with respect
to S-C V-TEL and the Purchaser, will be issued 105,840 shares of Common Stock
as compensation for his role as finder.

3.      The Company has agreed, subject to execution of definitive
documentation, to sell to an investor (a natural person) 175,000 shares of
Common Stock.

                                  Page 15

<PAGE>   16
                                   EXHIBIT B


Name:           Herald L. Ritch

Address of Principal Residence:

                10 Fort Hills Lane
                Greenwich, Connecticut 06831

Primary Occupation:

                Investment banker

Business Background (For at least the past ten years, provide history of
principal occupations, names of employers, positions held, nature of
responsibilities and relevant dates):

                1983-1988: Kidder, Peabody, Shareholder, Senior M&A banker.
                1988-1990: Freeman, Spogli & Co., general partner, principal 
                  investments.
                1991-present: DLJ, Managing Director, investment banking.

Professional Licenses:


Education (Include name of each post-secondary school attended, field of study,
degrees obtained, and relevant dates):

                Stanford University, BA--Economics, 1973
                Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, 1975


                                    Page 16



<PAGE>   17
Investment Experience (Describe prior experience in making investment decisions
either for self or on behalf of others):

        Extensive investment experience on behalf of myself & others

Net Worth (Mark amount that represents closest estimate):

        ( ) $250,000 or less            ( ) $1,000,000
        ( ) $500,000                    ( ) $2,500,000
        ( ) $750,000                    (X) $5,000,000 or more

        For purposes of this question, net worth is defined as the excess of
total assets at fair market value over total liabilities.

Income (Mark amount that represents closest estimate for each year):

        1991                    1992                    1993 (expected)
        ( ) $50,000 or less     ( ) $50,000 or less     ( ) $50,000 or less
        ( )  100,000            ( )  100,000            ( )  100,000
        ( )  200,000            ( )  200,000            ( )  200,000
        ( )  500,000            ( )  500,000            ( )  500,000
        (X)  1,000,000 or more  (X)  1,000,000 or more  (X)  1,000,000 or more

Purchaser Representatives (Mark statement that applies):

         X      The Purchaser is not relying upon any other person to evaluate
        ---     the merits and risks of acquiring shares of the Company's
                Common Stock.

                The Purchaser is relying upon each person named below for
        ---     assistance in evaluating the merits and risks of acquiring
                shares of the Company's Common Stock.

                Signature: H.J. Ritch
                           ------------------

                Date:      December 9, 1993

                                   Page 17
        

<PAGE>   18
                                   EXHIBIT C

As defined in Regulation D under the Securities Act, an investor is an
"accredited investor" if he, she or it meets one or more the following tests
(the following list omits certain tests that apply only to certain regulated
entities): 

1.      A corporation, Massachusetts or similar business trust, or partnership,
not formed for the specific purpose of acquiring shares of the Company's Common
Stock, with total assets in excess of $5,000,000.

2.      A natural person whose net worth, individually or jointly with spouse,
exceeds $1,000,000 (net worth may include the value of the Purchaser's
principal residence valued at either (x) cost, including cost of improvements,
net of current encumbrances on the property, or (y) appraised value as
determined by a written appraisal used by an institutional lender making a loan
secured by the property, including subsequent improvements, net of current
encumbrances on the property).

3.      A natural person who had an individual income in excess of $200,000 in
each of the two most recent calendar years or joint income with spouse in
excess of $300,000 in each of those years and has a reasonable expectation of
reaching the same income level in the current calendar year.

4.      A trust, with total assets in excess of $5,000,000, not formed for the
specific purpose of acquiring shares of the Company's Common Stock, whose
purchase is directed by a person who has such knowledge and experience in
financial and business matters that he or she is capable of evaluating the
merits and risks of an investment in shares of the Company's Common Stock.

5.      Any entity in which all the equity owners are accredited investors
(i.e., by virtue of their meeting any of the other tests for an "accredited
investor").



                                   Page 18


<PAGE>   1
                                                                   EXHIBIT 10.30



                                     [LOGO]



                                  July 30, 1996







Mr. Alan Levy
90 Elm Street
Tenafly, New Jersey 07670

Dear Mr. Levy:

The purpose of this letter is to set forth the agreement (this "Agreement")
between you and Viatel, Inc. and its subsidiaries ("Viatel") regarding your
resignation from Viatel as a director, officer and employee. As we have
discussed, Viatel desires to obtain your (i) release of all claims against
Viatel and (ii) agreement to maintain the confidentiality of business
information of Viatel of which you have become aware during the course of your
employment with Viatel and as a member of Viatel's Board of Directors. You have
agreed to the foregoing as consideration for Viatel's commitment to provide to
you the severance and other benefits set forth in paragraphs 2 through 6. Based
on these considerations, you have agreed with Viatel as follows:

1. RESIGNATION. Effective as of July 31, 1996, your resignation as an officer
and employee of Viatel is accepted. Your resignation as a member of Viatel's
Board of Directors shall be accepted as of July 12, 1996.

2. CONSULTANCY. (a) Consulting Services. You shall perform such consulting
services as may be reasonably requested in writing by Viatel from time to time
for up to four (4) hours per week during the period August 1, 1996 through July
31, 1997. You shall be available to render such services during normal business
hours, Monday through Friday, national and New York State holidays excepted, and
subject to reasonable absences for vacation and personal reasons (with respect
to any particular week). These services shall be performed wherever reasonably
appropriate to complete the necessary task.

                  (b) Consulting Fees. In return for the consulting services to
be provided by you hereunder, Viatel shall pay you $6,875 on the fifteen and
last days of each 


                                       1
<PAGE>   2
month (or the next business, if either such day is a Saturday, Sunday or
holiday) through January 15, 1997 and a lump sum of $89,375 on January 31, 1997
Such fee shall be paid without regard to the number of hours of services
actually provided pursuant to the terms hereof if Viatel does not request you to
provide the maximum number of hours contemplated. Your services hereunder shall
be performed as an independent contractor (and not as an employee) and shall not
be entitled to social security, unemployment or other benefits.

                  (c) Severance Period. The period from August 1, 1996 through
July 31, 1997 is hereafter referred to as the "Severance Period."

3. AWARDS.        (a) Outstanding Options and Restricted Shares. You have been 
granted 73,226 shares of common stock, par value $0.01, of Viatel (the "Common
Stock") and 80,000 restricted shares (the "Restricted Shares") of Common Stock
as specified below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
DESCRIPTION              GRANT           NUMBER OF         EXERCISE
                         DATE            SHARES            PRICE
<S>                      <C>             <C>               <C>  
Options                    9/93              3,226            $0.50



Options                  4/5/94             70,000            $2.49



Restricted               1/1/95             30,000            $ 0.0
  Shares

Options                  1/1/96            200,000            $3.49



Restricted               1/1/96             50,000            $ 0.0
  Shares
</TABLE>

                 (b) Vesting Provisions. Viatel and you hereby agree that you
(i) are fully vested as to 80,000 Restricted Shares and Options for 73,226
shares of Common Stock; (ii) hereby forfeit (and shall return to Viatel) the
option, granted as of January 1, 1996, for 200,000 shares of Common Stock
("Forfeited Option"); and (iii) have no entitlement, except as otherwise
specified herein, to any incentive performance awards, including awards or
vesting of cash bonuses, options and restricted stock, during the term of your
consultancy or thereafter.

4. EMPLOYEE BENEFITS. Except as to certain medical benefits, effective July 31,
1996, you shall no longer participate in Viatel's employee benefit plans. You
shall be entitled to continue your current medical benefits until December 31,
1996 at no cost to you. You may elect COBRA coverage for up to an 18-month
period, at your own expense.


                                       2
<PAGE>   3
More information on COBRA benefits will be provided to you within 14 days
following termination of Viatel health benefits.

5. REGISTRATION. Viatel hereby agrees to file a Form S-8 for Viatel's 1993
Flexible Incentive Stock Incentive Plan with the Securities and Exchange
Commission no later than October 31, 1996 covering your shares and options as
enumerated in Section 3 hereof. Should Viatel fail to file a Form S-8 by such
date, this Agreement shall be deemed void ab initio, and neither you nor Viatel
shall be entitled to any of the benefits hereunder; provided, however, that this
Agreement shall be of full force and effect if written notice specifying the
continuing vitality of this Agreement is received by Viatel from you no later
than November 15, 1996.

6. MUTUAL RELEASE. You hereby release and discharge Viatel, its affiliates and
their respective partners, directors, officers, employees and agents
(collectively, "Releasees") from any and all claims, actions, causes of action,
damages, liabilities, promises, debts, compensation, losses, obligations, costs
or expenses of any kind or nature, whether known or unknown, which you ever had,
now have or hereafter may have, against each or any of the Releasees, including,
but not limited to those arising from or related to your employment relationship
with Viatel or the termination of such employment, any alleged violation of any
covenant of good faith and fair dealing relative to your employment (including
any claim under either your July 17, 1995 employment agreement with Viatel or
any other similar understanding) or any applicable labor or employer-employee
statute, regulation or ordinance, whether federal, state or local (including, by
way of specificity but not of limitation, the Age Discrimination Act of 1967, as
amended, the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, the
Americans With Disabilities Act, the Older Workers Benefit Protection Act of
1990, as amended). Viatel hereby releases and discharges you from any and all
claims, actions, causes of action, damages, liabilities, promises, debts,
compensation, losses, obligations, costs or expenses of any kind or nature,
whether known or unknown, which Viatel ever had, now has or hereafter may have,
against you, including, but not limited to, those arising from your employment
relationship with Viatel or the termination of such employment. Notwithstanding
the foregoing, nothing in this Agreement shall be deemed to release (i) Viatel
from: (a) any indemnification obligations it may have to you arising out of your
duties as an officer or director of Viatel; (b) any obligation arising under the
Expatriate Agreement, dated March 31, 1995 (the "Expatriate Agreement"); or (c)
any other obligation arising under this Agreement; or (ii) you from any
obligation arising under this Agreement. With respect to clause (i)(a), Viatel
expressly acknowledges its continuing obligations arising under the
Indemnification Agreement dated November 11, 1994, between you and Viatel (the
"Indemnification Agreement").

7. PROTECTION OF REPUTATION. For a period of two years following the date of
this Agreement, neither party hereto will take any action which is intended, or
would reasonably be expected, to harm the other party or his or its reputation
or which would reasonably be expected to lead to unwanted or unfavorable
publicity to the other party; provided, however, the foregoing limitation shall
not apply to (a) compliance with any 


                                       3
<PAGE>   4
legal process or subpoena or (b) statements in response to authorized inquiry
from a court or regulatory body.

8. NONDISCLOSURE. You and Viatel agree that the terms and conditions of this
Agreement are confidential and that each will not, without the express prior
written consent of the other party, in any manner publish, publicize, disclose
or otherwise make known or permit or cause to be made known such terms and
conditions to anyone (other than such party's prospective or current lenders or
such party's financial and legal advisors, who shall agree to be bound by this
paragraph prior to disclosure of the terms or conditions hereof to such
persons), except as required by law, or in any proceeding to enforce the terms
of this Agreement.

9. CONFIDENTIALITY. You acknowledge that you have been provided, and during the
term of your consultancy hereunder may be provided, access to information of
Viatel (including, but not limited to, trade and industry secrets, customer
lists, sales records, operational systems, investment, market and other company
strategies and other proprietary commercial information) which constitutes
valuable, special and unique property of Viatel. You agree that you will not, at
any time or for any reason or purpose whatsoever, make use of, divulge or
otherwise disclose, directly or indirectly, any of such information to any
person or use any of such information for the personal gain of yourself or any
other person without Viatel's express prior written authorization; provided,
however, that the foregoing limitation shall not apply to (a) compliance with
any legal process or subpoena, (b) statements in response to authorized inquiry
from a court or regulatory body or (c) general discussions by you with
prospective employers and employment consultants regarding your activities,
roles and responsibilities while an employee of Viatel.

10. NON-SOLICITATION. For two (2) years from the date hereof, you hereby agree
to refrain from, directly, indirectly or as an agent on behalf of or in
conjunction with any person, soliciting or encouraging (other than employee
referrals and similar activities consistent with past practice) any employee of
Viatel or any of its subsidiaries who is employed in an executive, managerial,
administrative or professional capacity or who possesses any confidential
information (as specified in Section 9 hereof), to leave the employment of
Viatel or any subsidiaries.

11. REMEDIES. Subject to the termination of this Agreement under Section 5
hereof, if either party breaches its obligations under Section 6, 7 or 8 of this
Agreement or if you breach your obligations under Section 9 or 10, the
non-breaching party, in addition to and not in lieu of any other rights and
remedies it may have at law or in equity, shall have the right to obtain
injunctive relief, it being acknowledged and agreed by both parties that any
such breach would cause irreparable and continuing injury to the non-breaching
party and that money damages alone would not provide an adequate remedy to such
non-breaching party. Viatel shall have the additional right, upon any such
breach, of offsetting against any amount otherwise due to you (whether under
this Agreement or otherwise) an aggregate maximum of $10,000; provided, however,
that 


                                       4
<PAGE>   5
before offsetting any amount, Viatel must furnish you with ten (10) business
days' written notice.

12. NO WAIVER. No delay or failure by either party to this Agreement to exercise
any right under this Agreement and no partial or single exercise of that right
shall constitute a waiver of that or any other right. No waiver shall be valid
unless in writing and signed by you or an authorized officer of Viatel, as the
case may be, and any waiver by either party of a breach of any provision hereof
shall not be construed as a waiver of any subsequent breach or violation
thereof.

13. SEVERABILITY. If any provision of this Agreement shall hereafter be held to
be invalid, unenforceable or illegal in whole or in part, in any jurisdiction
under any circumstances for any reason, (i) such provision shall be reformed to
the minimum extent necessary to cause such provision to be valid, enforceable
and legal while preserving the intent of the parties as expressed in, and the
benefits to the parties provided by, this Agreement or (ii) if such provision
cannot be so reformed, such provision shall be severed from this Agreement and
an equitable adjustment shall be made to this Agreement (including, without
limitation, addition of necessary further provisions to this Agreement) so as to
give effect to the intent as so expressed and the benefits so provided. Such
holding shall not affect or impair the validity, enforceability or legality of
such provision in any other jurisdiction or under any other circumstances.
Neither such holding nor such reformation or severance shall affect or impair
the legality, validity or enforceability of any other provision of this
Agreement.

14. GOVERNING LAW; SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION. THE VALIDITY, INTERPRETATION,
PERFORMANCE AND ENFORCEMENT OF THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF
THE STATE OF NEW YORK (WITHOUT GIVING EFFECT TO THE LAWS, RULES AND PRINCIPLES
OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK REGARDING CONFLICTS OF LAWS). You and Viatel agree that
any action, proceeding or claim arising out of, or relating in any way to, this
Agreement shall be brought and enforced in the courts of the State of New York
and irrevocably submit to such jurisdiction, which jurisdiction shall be
exclusive. You and Viatel hereby irrevocably waive any objection to such
jurisdiction or inconvenient forum.

15. MISCELLANEOUS. This Agreement may not be amended except by a written
agreement signed by you and a duly authorized officer of Viatel. This Agreement
shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of each of you and Viatel and
your heirs, legal administrators and assigns and Viatel's successors and
assigns.

16. OPPORTUNITY TO REVIEW. You acknowledge and agree that you have been given a
reasonable period, up to and including 21 days, to review and sign this
Agreement, and if you sign this Agreement prior to the expiration of 21 days,
you do so knowingly and voluntarily, and you acknowledge and agree that you
could have requested more time to review and sign this Agreement, that you did
not want to or need such further time and that you did not request it.


                                       5
<PAGE>   6
17. RIGHT TO REVOKE THIS AGREEMENT. You acknowledge that you signed this
Agreement on the date set forth above. In accordance with applicable law, you
may revoke this Agreement at any time during the seven-day period after you sign
this Agreement. Such revocation may be made by delivering a written notice of
revocation to Viatel during such seven day period. This Agreement will not be
effective or enforceable until the date on which the revocation period has
expired (the "Effective Date").

        PLEASE READ THIS AGREEMENT CAREFULLY. BY EXECUTING THIS AGREEMENT, YOU
        WILL HAVE WAIVED ANY RIGHT YOU MAY HAVE TO BRING A LAWSUIT OR MAKE ANY
        LEGAL CLAIM, KNOWN OR UNKNOWN, AGAINST VIATEL BASED ON ANY ACTIONS TAKEN
        BY VIATEL, ITS EMPLOYEES OR AGENTS ARISING FROM OR RELATED TO YOUR
        EMPLOYMENT WITH VIATEL OR THE TERMINATION OF SUCH EMPLOYMENT, UP TO THE
        DATE OF THE EXECUTION OF THIS AGREEMENT. WE RECOMMEND THAT YOU RETAIN
        LEGAL COUNSEL TO ADVISE YOU WITH RESPECT TO THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT
        AND THE TERMINATION OF YOUR EMPLOYMENT WITH VIATEL.

If you agree that this letter appropriately sets forth the terms of your
severance agreement, please sign the enclosed duplicate copy of this letter and
return it to the undersigned.



                                   Sincerely yours,



                                   VIATEL, INC.
                                   By:

                                   /s/ Martin Varsavsky
                                   -------------------------
                                   Martin Varsavsky, President





Agreed as of the date
first written above
 
/s/ Alan L. Levy
- -------------------------
Alan L. Levy
                                  
 
                                        6


<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.2
 
                  ACCOUNTANTS' REPORT ON SCHEDULE AND CONSENT
 
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Viatel, Inc. and Subsidiaries:
 
     The audits referred to in our report dated March 8, 1996, included the
related financial statement schedule as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and for
each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1995, included in
the registration statement. This financial statement schedule is the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on this financial statement schedule based on our audits. In our
opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the
basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all
material respects the information set forth therein.
 
     We consent to the use of our reports included herein and to the references
to our firm under the headings "Summary Consolidated Financial and Other Data,"
"Selected Consolidated Financial and Other Data" and "Experts" in the
prospectus.
 
                                          /s/ KPMG PEAT MARWICK LLP
 
New York, New York
August 7, 1996

<PAGE>   1
                                                                Exhibit 23.3


                         INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT


The Boards of Directors and Stockholders
Viatel, Inc. and Subsidiaries:


We consent to the reference to our firm under the heading "Selected
Consolidated Financial and Other Data" in the prospectus.


                                        /s/ Edward Isaacs & Company LLP
                                        ----------------------------------
                                        EDWARD ISAACS & COMPANY LLP


New York, New York
August 6, 1996

WARNING: THE EDGAR SYSTEM ENCOUNTERED ERROR(S) WHILE PROCESSING THIS SCHEDULE.

<TABLE> <S> <C>

                                                                   Exhibit 27.1
<ARTICLE> 5
<LEGEND>
THIS SCHEDULE CONTAINS SUMMARY FINANCIAL INFORMATION EXTRACTED FROM THE AUDITED
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
1995 AND IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY REFERENCE TO SUCH CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.
</LEGEND>
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   YEAR
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                    December 31, 1995
<PERIOD-END>                         December 31, 1995        
<CASH>                                       8,934,914
<SECURITIES>                                26,131,492
<RECEIVABLES>                                4,723,664
<ALLOWANCES>                                   473,000
<INVENTORY>                                          0
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                            42,163,106
<PP&E>                                      15,715,121
<DEPRECIATION>                               2,781,122
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                              65,613,446
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                       15,948,518
<BONDS>                                     67,283,008
                                0
                                          0
<COMMON>                                       204,615
<OTHER-SE>                                  30,030,805
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                65,613,446
<SALES>                                              0
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                            32,313,293
<CGS>                                                0
<TOTAL-COSTS>                               27,648,340
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                            27,524,743
<LOSS-PROVISION>                             1,229,473
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                           8,856,317
<INCOME-PRETAX>                           (28,475,711)
<INCOME-TAX>                                         0
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                       (28,475,711)
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0
<CHANGES>                                            0
<NET-INCOME>                              (28,475,711)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                   (1.39)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                   (1.39)
        

</TABLE>
WARNING: THE EDGAR SYSTEM ENCOUNTERED ERROR(S) WHILE PROCESSING THIS SCHEDULE.

<TABLE> <S> <C>

                                                                    Exhibit 27.2
<ARTICLE> 5
<LEGEND>
THIS SCHEDULE CONTAINS SUMMARY FINANCIAL INFORMATION EXTRACTED FROM THE
UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE COMPANY FOR THE THREE MONTHS
ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 AND IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY REFERENCE TO SUCH
UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.
</LEGEND>
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   3-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                    December 31, 1996
<PERIOD-END>                            March 31, 1996
<CASH>                                       1,905,401
<SECURITIES>                                21,176,310
<RECEIVABLES>                                5,462,506
<ALLOWANCES>                                   549,000
<INVENTORY>                                          0
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                            32,476,232
<PP&E>                                      17,589,704
<DEPRECIATION>                               3,654,366
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                              57,483,426
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                       14,330,515
<BONDS>                                     69,791,255
                                0
                                          0
<COMMON>                                       204,615
<OTHER-SE>                                  30,030,805
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                57,483,426
<SALES>                                              0
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                            10,590,270
<CGS>                                                0
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                8,999,249
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                             8,617,991
<LOSS-PROVISION>                               373,037
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                           2,569,196
<INCOME-PRETAX>                            (9,126,824)
<INCOME-TAX>                                         0
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                        (9,126,824)
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0
<CHANGES>                                            0
<NET-INCOME>                               (9,126,824)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                   (0.45)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                   (0.45)
        

</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission